0e197c3ca2acb18af60739ffd3a24b30d4243ecd
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Daemon Configuration:: Daemon Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * NAND Flash Commands:: NAND Flash Commands
77 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
78 * General Commands:: General Commands
79 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
80 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
81 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
82 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
83 * TFTP:: TFTP
84 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
85 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
86 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
87 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
88 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
89
90 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
91 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
92 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
93 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
94 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
95 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
96 @end menu
97
98 @node About
99 @unnumbered About
100 @cindex about
101
102 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
103 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
104 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
105 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
106 around the world.
107
108 @section What is OpenOCD?
109 @cindex TAP
110 @cindex JTAG
111
112 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
113 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
114 devices.
115
116 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
117 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
118 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
119 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
120 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
121 needed to hook up to the target.
122
123 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
124 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
125 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
126 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
127 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
128
129 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
130 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
131 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
132 let the development board connect directly to the debug
133 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
134
135 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
136 signaling, and is used to communicate
137 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
138 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
139 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
140 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
141 scan operations.
142
143 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
144 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
145 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
146 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
147
148 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
149 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
150 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
151 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
152
153
154 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
155 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
156 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
157
158 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
159 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
160 (Stellaris LM3, ST STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and Intel Quark (x10xx)
161 based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
162
163 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
164 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
165 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
166 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
167 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
168
169 @section OpenOCD Web Site
170
171 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
172
173 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
174
175 @section Latest User's Guide:
176
177 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
178 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
179 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
180
181 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
182
183 PDF form is likewise published at:
184
185 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
186
187 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
188
189 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
190 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
191 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
192 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
193 instead of this forum.
194
195 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
196
197 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
198
199 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
200 communication between users:
201
202 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
203
204 @section OpenOCD IRC
205
206 Support can also be found on irc:
207 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
208
209 @node Developers
210 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
211 @cindex developers
212
213 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
214 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
215 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
216 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
217
218 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
219 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
220
221 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
222
223 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
224 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
225
226 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
227
228 or via http
229
230 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
231
232 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
233
234 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
235
236 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
237 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
238 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
239 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
240 needing a Git client:
241
242 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
243
244 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
245 from the repository or a snapshot.
246
247 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
248 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
249 Patches created against older versions may require additional
250 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
251
252 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
253
254 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
255 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
256 technical information about the software internals, development
257 processes, and similar documentation:
258
259 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
260
261 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
262 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
263 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
264
265 @section Gerrit Review System
266
267 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
268 Code Review System:
269
270 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
271
272 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
273 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
274 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
275 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
276 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
277
278 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
279 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
280 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
281 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
282 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
283
284 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
285
286 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
287 communication between developers:
288
289 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
290
291 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
292
293 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
294
295 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
296
297
298 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
300 @cindex dongles
301 @cindex FTDI
302 @cindex wiggler
303 @cindex zy1000
304 @cindex printer port
305 @cindex USB Adapter
306 @cindex RTCK
307
308 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
309 an adapter .... [snip]
310
311 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
312 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
313 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
314 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
315 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
316 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
317 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
318
319
320 @section Choosing a Dongle
321
322 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
323
324 @enumerate
325 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
326 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
327 other ways to communicate with target devices.
328 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
329 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
330 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
331 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
332 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
333 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
334 Ethernet port needed?
335 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
336 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
337 @end enumerate
338
339 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
340
341 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
342 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
343 running on the developer's host computer.
344 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
345 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
346 IP address assigned to the probe.
347 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
348 OpenOCD debugger.
349 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
350 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
351 the target.
352 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
353 to power cycle the target remotely.
354
355 For more information, visit:
356
357 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
358
359 @section USB FT2232 Based
360
361 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
362 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
363 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
364 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
365 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
366 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
367 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
368 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
369 clocking.)
370
371 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
372 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
373 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
374 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
375 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
376
377 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
378 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
379
380 @itemize @bullet
381 @item @b{usbjtag}
382 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
383 @item @b{jtagkey}
384 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
385 @item @b{jtagkey2}
386 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
387 @item @b{oocdlink}
388 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
389 @item @b{signalyzer}
390 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
391 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
392 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
393 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
394 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
395 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
396 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
397 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
398 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
399 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
400 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
401 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
402 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
403 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
404 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
405 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
406 @item @b{turtelizer2}
407 @* See:
408 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
409 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
410 @item @b{comstick}
411 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
412 @item @b{stm32stick}
413 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
414 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
415 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
416 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
417 @item @b{cortino}
418 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
419 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
420 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
421 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
422 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
423 @item @b{opendous}
424 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
425 (OpenHardware).
426 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
427 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
428
429 @item @b{GW16042}
430 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
431 FT2232H-based
432
433 @end itemize
434 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
435
436 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
437 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
438 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
439 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
440 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
441
442 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
443 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
444 (see the section on driver commands).
445
446 @itemize
447 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
448 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
449 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
450 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
451 @end itemize
452
453 @section USB JLINK based
454 There are several OEM versions of the Segger @b{JLINK} adapter. It is
455 an example of a micro controller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
456 AT91SAM764 internally.
457
458 @itemize @bullet
459 @item @b{ATMEL SAMICE} Only works with ATMEL chips!
460 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/dyn/products/tools_card.asp?tool_id=3892}
461 @item @b{SEGGER JLINK}
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
463 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
464 @* Link: @url{http://www.iar.com/en/products/hardware-debug-probes/iar-j-link/}
465 @end itemize
466
467 @section USB RLINK based
468 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
469 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
470 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
471
472 @itemize @bullet
473 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
477 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
478 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
479 @end itemize
480
481 @section USB ST-LINK based
482 ST Micro has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
483 They only work with ST Micro chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
484
485 @itemize @bullet
486 @item @b{ST-LINK}
487 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
488 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
489 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
490 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
491 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
492 @end itemize
493
494 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
495 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
496 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
497 @itemize @bullet
498 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
499 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
500 @end itemize
501
502 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
503 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
504 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
505 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
506
507 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
508 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
509 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
510
511 @section USB Other
512 @itemize @bullet
513 @item @b{USBprog}
514 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
515
516 @item @b{USB - Presto}
517 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
518
519 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
520 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
521
522 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
523 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
524
525 @item @b{Buspirate}
526 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
527
528 @item @b{opendous}
529 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
530
531 @item @b{estick}
532 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
533
534 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
536 @end itemize
537
538 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
539
540 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
541 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
542 these on the market.
543
544 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
545 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
546 of USB-based ones.
547
548 @itemize @bullet
549
550 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
551 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
552
553 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
554 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
555 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
556
557 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
558 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
559
560 @item @b{Wiggler2}
561 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
562
563 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
564 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
565
566 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
567 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
568
569 @item @b{arm-jtag}
570 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
571
572 @item @b{chameleon}
573 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
574
575 @item @b{Triton}
576 @* Unknown.
577
578 @item @b{Lattice}
579 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
580 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
581
582 @item @b{flashlink}
583 @* From ST Microsystems;
584 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
585
586 @end itemize
587
588 @section Other...
589 @itemize @bullet
590
591 @item @b{ep93xx}
592 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
593
594 @item @b{at91rm9200}
595 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
596
597 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
598 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
599
600 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
601 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
602 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
603
604 @end itemize
605
606 @node About Jim-Tcl
607 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
608 @cindex Jim-Tcl
609 @cindex tcl
610
611 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
612 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
613 command interpreter.
614
615 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
616 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
617 much of anything about Tcl.
618 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
619
620 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
621 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
622 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
623 OpenOCD mailing list.
624
625 @itemize @bullet
626 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
627 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
628 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
629 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
630 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
631 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
632
633 @item @b{Missing Features}
634 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
635 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
636 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
637 enabled in OpenOCD.
638
639 @item @b{Scripts}
640 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
641 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
642 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
643
644 @item @b{Commands}
645 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
646 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
647 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
648 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
649
650 @item @b{Historical Note}
651 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
652 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
653 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
654 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
655
656 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
657 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
658 @end itemize
659
660 @node Running
661 @chapter Running
662 @cindex command line options
663 @cindex logfile
664 @cindex directory search
665
666 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
667 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
668 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
669 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
670 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
671 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
672 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
673
674 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
675 tell it how each debug session should work.
676 The @option{--help} option shows:
677 @verbatim
678 bash$ openocd --help
679
680 --help | -h display this help
681 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
682 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
683 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
684 --debug | -d set debug level <0-3>
685 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
686 --command | -c run <command>
687 @end verbatim
688
689 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
690 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
691 To specify one or more different
692 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
693
694 @example
695 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
696 @end example
697
698 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
699 @enumerate
700 @item the current directory,
701 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
702 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
703 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
704 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
705 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
706 @end enumerate
707 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
708
709 @quotation Note
710 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
711 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
712 @end quotation
713
714 @section Simple setup, no customization
715
716 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
717 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
718 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
719 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
720 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
721
722 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
723 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
724 the server with some variation of one of the following:
725
726 @example
727 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
728 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
729 @end example
730
731 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
732 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
733 If all goes well you'll see output something like
734
735 @example
736 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
737 For bug reports, read
738 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
739 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
740 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
741 @end example
742
743 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
744 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
745 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
746
747 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
748
749 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
750 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
751 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
752 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
753 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
754 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
755 ensure that this always succeeds.
756 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a daemon.
757 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
758 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
759 and then shut down without acting as a daemon.
760
761 Once OpenOCD starts running as a daemon, it waits for connections from
762 clients (Telnet, GDB, Other) and processes the commands issued through
763 those channels.
764
765 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
766 the @option{-d} option.
767
768 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
769 @option{-c} command line switch.
770
771 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
772 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
773 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
774 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
775 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
776 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
777 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
778
779 You can redirect all output from the daemon to a file using the
780 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
781
782 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
783 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
784 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
785 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
786
787 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
788 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
789
790 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
791 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
792 and start the OpenOCD server.
793 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
794 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
795 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
796 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
797
798 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
799
800 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
801 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
802 and a USB cable on the other.
803 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
804 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
805
806 @enumerate
807 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
808 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
809 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
810 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
811 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
812 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
813 debugging host.
814
815 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
816 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
817 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
818 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
819 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
820
821 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
822 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
823 with 1.2 Volt boards.
824
825 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
826 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
827 ways to connect the cable.
828 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
829 Be sure it's firmly connected.
830
831 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
832 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
833 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
834 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
835 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
836 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
837 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
838 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
839
840 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
841 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
842 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
843 but are tedious to set up.
844 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
845 adapter signals to the right board pins.
846
847 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
848 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
849 you are using to run OpenOCD.
850 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
851
852 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
853 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
854 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
855 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
856
857 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
858 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
859 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
860
861 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
862 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
863 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
864 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
865
866 @end enumerate
867
868 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
869 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
870 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
871
872 @section Project Directory
873
874 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
875
876 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
877 single directory for your work with a given board.
878 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
879 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
880 files accessed through semihosting,
881 and for code you upload to the target board.
882 It is also the natural place to write files,
883 such as log files and data you download from the board.
884
885 @section Configuration Basics
886
887 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
888 a variety of ways you can mix them.
889 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
890
891 @itemize
892 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
893 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
894 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
895 @end itemize
896
897 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
898 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
899 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
900
901 @example
902 source [find interface/signalyzer.cfg]
903
904 # GDB can also flash my flash!
905 gdb_memory_map enable
906 gdb_flash_program enable
907
908 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
909 @end example
910
911 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
912
913 @example
914 openocd -f interface/signalyzer.cfg \
915 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
916 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
917 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
918 @end example
919
920 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
921 each supporting a different development task.
922 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
923 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
924
925 @quotation Important
926 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
927 problems with how it treats variables.
928 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
929 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
930 that can be tested in a later script.
931 @end quotation
932
933 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
934 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
935 to simplify your work.
936
937 @section User Config Files
938 @cindex config file, user
939 @cindex user config file
940 @cindex config file, overview
941
942 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
943 in one place.
944 One of the following will match your situation best:
945
946 @itemize
947 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
948 provided by someone else.
949 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
950 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
951 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
952 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
953 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
954 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
955
956 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
957 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
958
959 @enumerate
960 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
961 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
962 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
963 @end enumerate
964
965 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
966 The first is an interface config file.
967 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
968 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
969 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
970 meet your deadline:
971
972 @example
973 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
974 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
975 @end example
976
977 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
978 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
979 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
980 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
981
982 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
983 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
984 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
985 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
986 target and board
987 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
988 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
989
990 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
991 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
992 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
993 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
994
995 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
996 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
997 giving access to your particular flash chips.
998 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
999 for a new chip built around the Cortex M3 core.
1000
1001 @quotation Note
1002 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1003 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1004 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1005 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1006 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1007 @end quotation
1008
1009 @item
1010 You may may need to write some C code.
1011 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1012 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1013 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1014 a new chip architecture.
1015 @end itemize
1016
1017 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1018 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1019 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1020
1021 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1022 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1023 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1024 @itemize
1025
1026 @item
1027 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1028 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1029 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1030 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1031
1032 @item
1033 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1034 @cindex vector_catch
1035 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1036 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a timesaver
1037 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1038 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1039 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1040 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1041
1042 @item
1043 You might need to override some defaults.
1044 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1045 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1046
1047 @item
1048 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1049 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1050 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1051 @end itemize
1052
1053 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1054
1055 A few project-specific utility
1056 routines may well speed up your work.
1057 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1058
1059 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1060 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1061 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1062 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1063 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1064 may help:
1065
1066 @example
1067 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1068 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1069 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1070 # Leave the CPU halted.
1071 reset init
1072
1073 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1074 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1075
1076 # Start running.
1077 resume 0x20000000
1078 @}
1079 @end example
1080
1081 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1082 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1083 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1084 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1085 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1086
1087 @example
1088 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1089 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1090 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1091 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1092 reset init
1093
1094 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1095 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1096 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1097 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1098 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1099 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1100 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1101
1102 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1103 reset run
1104 @}
1105 @end example
1106
1107 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1108 from NAND.
1109 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1110 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1111 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1112
1113 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1114 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1115
1116 @section Target Software Changes
1117
1118 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1119 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1120 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1121 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1122 handling issues like:
1123
1124 @itemize @bullet
1125
1126 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1127 Watchog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1128 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1129 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1130 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1131 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1132 your debug sessions.
1133
1134 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1135 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1136 That might however be your only option.
1137
1138 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1139 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1140 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1141 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1142 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1143 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1144 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1145 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1146 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1147 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1148 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1149 instead of the whole thing.
1150 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1151 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1152
1153 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1154 @cindex ARM semihosting
1155 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1156 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1157 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1158 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1159 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1160 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1161 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1162 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1163 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1164 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1165 NAND or SPI flash.
1166
1167 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1168 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1169 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1170 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1171 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1172
1173 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1174 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1175 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1176 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1177 registers which can be used to change various features including
1178 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1179 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1180 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1181 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1182 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1183
1184 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1185 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1186 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1187 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1188 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1189
1190 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1191 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1192 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1193 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1194 early code execution can be debugged
1195 or firmware can be replaced.
1196
1197 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1198 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1199 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1200 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1201 operations like writing to memory.)
1202
1203 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1204 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1205 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1206 various kinds of message.
1207 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1208
1209 @end itemize
1210
1211 @section Target Hardware Setup
1212
1213 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1214 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1215 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1216 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1217 working with.}
1218
1219 Common issues include:
1220
1221 @itemize @bullet
1222
1223 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1224 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1225 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1226 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1227 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1228 or one from a daughtercard).
1229 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1230 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1231
1232 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1233 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1234 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1235 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1236 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1237 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1238
1239 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1240 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1241 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1242 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1243 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1244
1245
1246 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1247 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1248 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1249 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1250 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1251 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1252 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1253
1254 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1255 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1256 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1257 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1258 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1259
1260 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1261 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1262 used to start booting.
1263
1264 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1265 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1266 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1267 multiple audio codec chips).
1268 This interacts with software
1269 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1270 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1271 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1272 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1273 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1274 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1275 audio or video codecs are used.
1276
1277 @end itemize
1278
1279 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1280 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1281 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1282 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1283 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1284 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1285 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1286 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1287 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1288 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1289
1290
1291 @node Config File Guidelines
1292 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1293
1294 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1295 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1296 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1297 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1298
1299 You should find the following directories under
1300 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1301 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1302 @itemize @bullet
1303 @item @file{interface} ...
1304 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1305 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1306 @item @file{board} ...
1307 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1308 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1309
1310 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1311 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1312 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1313 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1314 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1315 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1316 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1317 a CPU and an FPGA.
1318 @item @file{target} ...
1319 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1320 on a chip
1321 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1322 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1323 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1324 the target config file defines all of them.
1325 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1326 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1327 @end itemize
1328
1329 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1330 file may override features in any of the above files by
1331 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1332 commands specific to their situation.
1333
1334 @section Interface Config Files
1335
1336 The user config file
1337 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1338
1339 @example
1340 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1341 @end example
1342
1343 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1344 in use today with OpenOCD.
1345 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1346 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1347
1348 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1349 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1350 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1351 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1352 and need to provide a driver for it.
1353
1354 @section Board Config Files
1355 @cindex config file, board
1356 @cindex board config file
1357
1358 The user config file
1359 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1360
1361 @example
1362 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1363 @end example
1364
1365 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1366 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1367 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1368
1369 @enumerate
1370 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1371 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1372 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1373 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1374 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1375 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1376 @end enumerate
1377
1378 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1379 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1380 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1381 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1382
1383 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1384 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1385 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1386 configuration works.
1387
1388 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1389
1390 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1391 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1392 convention on how to use certain variables.
1393
1394 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1395 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1396 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1397 used at will within a target configuration file.
1398
1399 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1400 for a board with three chips:
1401
1402 @example
1403 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1404 set CHIPNAME network
1405 set ENDIAN big
1406 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1407 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1408 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1409 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1410
1411 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1412 set CHIPNAME video
1413 set ENDIAN little
1414 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1415 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1416 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1417 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1418
1419 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1420 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1421 unset ENDIAN
1422 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1423 @end example
1424
1425 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1426 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1427 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1428 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1429 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1430 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1431 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1432 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1433
1434 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1435 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1436 naming collisions.
1437
1438 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1439 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1440 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1441 up other clocks and peripherals.
1442
1443 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1444 @cindex variable names
1445
1446 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1447 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1448 one such chip (as shown above).
1449 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1450 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1451 to promote consistency and
1452 so that board files can override target defaults.
1453
1454 Inputs to target config files include:
1455
1456 @itemize @bullet
1457 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1458 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1459 tap identifier dotted names.
1460 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1461 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1462 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1463 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1464 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1465 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1466 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1467 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1468 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1469 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1470 @end itemize
1471
1472 Outputs from target config files include:
1473
1474 @itemize @bullet
1475 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1476 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1477 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1478 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1479 specific to that board and that target.
1480 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1481 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1482 @end itemize
1483
1484 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1485 @cindex event, reset-init
1486 @cindex reset-init handler
1487
1488 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1489 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1490 fully set up yet.
1491 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1492 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1493 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1494 handler is one of the most important.
1495
1496 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1497 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1498 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1499 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1500 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1501
1502 @quotation Note
1503 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1504 are included here.
1505 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1506 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1507 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1508 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1509 @end quotation
1510
1511 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1512 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1513 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1514 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1515 those as parameters.
1516 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1517 and disabling the watchdog.
1518 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1519 the next developer doing such work.
1520 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1521
1522 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1523 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1524 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1525 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1526
1527 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1528
1529 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1530 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1531 a low JTAG clock rate.
1532 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1533 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1534 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1535 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1536 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1537 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1538 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1539
1540 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1541 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1542 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1543 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1544 which might be less than that.
1545
1546 @quotation Warning
1547 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1548 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1549 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1550 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1551 @end quotation
1552
1553 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1554 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1555 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1556 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1557 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1558 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1559
1560 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1561 @subsection The init_board procedure
1562 @cindex init_board procedure
1563
1564 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1565 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1566 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1567 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1568 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1569 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1570 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1571 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1572 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1573 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1574 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1575 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1576
1577 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1578 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1579
1580 @example
1581 ### board_file.cfg ###
1582
1583 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1584 source [find target/target.cfg]
1585
1586 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1587 # enables fast on-board clock source
1588 # configures the chip to use it
1589 @}
1590
1591 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1592 proc init_board @{@} @{
1593 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1594
1595 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1596 adapter_khz 1
1597 enable_fast_clock
1598 adapter_khz 10000
1599 @}
1600 @}
1601 @end example
1602
1603 @section Target Config Files
1604 @cindex config file, target
1605 @cindex target config file
1606
1607 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1608 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1609 more target config files like this:
1610
1611 @example
1612 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1613 @end example
1614
1615 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1616 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1617 In summary the target files should contain
1618
1619 @enumerate
1620 @item Set defaults
1621 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1622 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1623 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1624 @item On-Chip flash
1625 @end enumerate
1626
1627 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1628 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1629 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1630
1631 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1632 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1633 can talk to the chip.
1634 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1635 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1636 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1637 and other processing engines.
1638
1639 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1640
1641 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1642 letting board config files express environment-specific
1643 differences in how things should be set up.
1644
1645 @example
1646 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1647 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1648 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1649 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1650 @} else @{
1651 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1652 @}
1653
1654 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1655 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1656 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1657 @} else @{
1658 set _ENDIAN little
1659 @}
1660
1661 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1662 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1663 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1664 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1665 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1666 @} else @{
1667 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1668 @}
1669 @end example
1670 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1671
1672 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1673 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1674 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1675
1676 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1677 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1678 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1679
1680 @example
1681 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1682 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1683 @end example
1684
1685 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1686 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1687 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1688 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1689 for taps.
1690
1691 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1692 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1693 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1694 looks (in part) like this:
1695
1696 @example
1697 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1698 @end example
1699
1700 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1701 to source such a config file twice, with different
1702 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1703 it adds a different TAP each time.
1704
1705 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1706 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1707 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1708 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1709
1710 @example
1711 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1712 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1713 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1714 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1715 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1716 @end example
1717
1718 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1719 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1720
1721 @itemize
1722 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1723 plus a JRC to enable them
1724 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1725 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1726 is not currently used)
1727 @end itemize
1728
1729 @subsection Add CPU targets
1730
1731 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1732 GDB and other commands can use it.
1733 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1734 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1735 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1736 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1737
1738 @example
1739 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1740 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1741 @end example
1742
1743 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1744 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1745 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1746 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1747 a work area if you can.
1748 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1749
1750 @example
1751 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1752 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1753 @end example
1754
1755 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1756 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1757 @cindex SMP
1758 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1759
1760 @example
1761 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1762 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1763 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1764 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1765 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1766 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1767 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1768 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1769 @end example
1770 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1771 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1772 @itemize @bullet
1773 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1774 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1775 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1776 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1777 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1778 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1779 @end itemize
1780
1781 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1782 command have been implemented.
1783 @itemize @bullet
1784 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1785 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1786 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1787 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1788 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1789 following example.
1790 @end itemize
1791
1792 @example
1793 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1794 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1795 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1796 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1797 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1798 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1799 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1800 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1801 > resume
1802 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1803 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1804 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1805 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1806 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1807 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1808 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1809 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1810 @end example
1811
1812
1813 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1814
1815 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1816 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1817 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1818
1819 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1820 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1821 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1822 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1823 both signals.
1824
1825 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1826 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1827 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1828 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1829 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1830 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1831 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1832 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1833 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1834 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1835 not available.)
1836
1837 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1838 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1839 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1840 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1841 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1842 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1843 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1844 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1845
1846 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1847 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1848 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1849 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1850 slower clock than they will use later.
1851 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1852 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1853 than they will use later.
1854 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1855
1856 @quotation Important
1857 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1858 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1859 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1860 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1861 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1862 @end quotation
1863
1864 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1865 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1866 @cindex init_targets procedure
1867
1868 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1869 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1870 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1871 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1872 Such procedure can be overriden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1873 This concept faciliates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1874 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enchanced or changed in
1875 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1876 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1877
1878 @example
1879 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1880
1881 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1882 # basic initialization procedure ...
1883 @}
1884
1885 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1886 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1887 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1888 @}
1889
1890 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1891
1892 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1893
1894 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1895 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1896 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1897 @}
1898 @end example
1899
1900 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1901 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1902
1903 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1904
1905 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1906 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1907
1908 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1909 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1910 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1911
1912 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1913 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1914 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1915 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1916 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1917 events already assigned.
1918
1919 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1920
1921 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1922 special high speed download features - enable it.
1923
1924 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1925
1926 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1927 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1928 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1929 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1930 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1931 If you are using an external trace port,
1932 configure it in your board config file.
1933 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1934 configure it in your target config file.
1935
1936 @example
1937 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1938 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1939 @end example
1940
1941 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1942
1943 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1944
1945 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1946 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1947 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1948 the TARGET (chip) file.
1949
1950 Examples:
1951 @itemize @bullet
1952 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1953 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1954 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1955 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1956 @end itemize
1957
1958 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1959 @section Translating Configuration Files
1960 @cindex translation
1961 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1962 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1963 Lauterbach, Segger, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1964 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1965 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1966 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1967
1968 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1969 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1970 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1971 convert other scripts later on.
1972
1973 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1974 replace job:
1975
1976 @example
1977 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1978 #
1979 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1980 #
1981 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1982 #
1983 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1984
1985 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1986 global TARGETNAME
1987
1988 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
1989
1990 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
1991 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
1992 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
1993 @}
1994 @end example
1995
1996
1997
1998 @node Daemon Configuration
1999 @chapter Daemon Configuration
2000 @cindex initialization
2001 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2002 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2003 supported.
2004
2005 @anchor{configurationstage}
2006 @section Configuration Stage
2007 @cindex configuration stage
2008 @cindex config command
2009
2010 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2011 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2012 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2013 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2014 inside startup scripts.
2015
2016 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2017 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2018 which may be issued interactively.
2019 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2020 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2021
2022 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2023 flash banks,
2024 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2025 and other basic setup.
2026 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2027 may access or activate TAPs.
2028 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2029 longer be issued.
2030
2031 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2032 @section Entering the Run Stage
2033
2034 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2035 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2036 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2037 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2038 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2039 You should see no errors at this point.
2040 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2041 commands you used to configure the server.
2042 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2043 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2044 on the scan chain.
2045
2046 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2047 become available.
2048 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2049 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2050 a target has been successfuly instantiated.
2051 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2052 entry to the run stage.
2053
2054 @deffn {Config Command} init
2055 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2056 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2057 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2058 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2059 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2060 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2061
2062 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2063 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2064 configuration files and/or command line options.
2065
2066 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2067 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2068 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2069 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2070 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2071 @end deffn
2072
2073 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2074 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2075 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2076
2077 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2078 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2079 scan chain.
2080 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2081 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2082
2083 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2084 they return.
2085 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2086 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2087 @end deffn
2088
2089 @anchor{tcpipports}
2090 @section TCP/IP Ports
2091 @cindex TCP port
2092 @cindex server
2093 @cindex port
2094 @cindex security
2095 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2096 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2097 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2098
2099 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2100 access using one or more of these ports.
2101 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as zero.
2102 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2103 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2104
2105 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2106 @cindex GDB server
2107 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2108 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2109 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2110 the normal use cases.
2111
2112 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2113 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disable"
2114 disables the gdb server.
2115
2116 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2117 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2118
2119 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2120 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2121
2122 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2123 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2124 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2125
2126 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2127 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2128 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2129 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2130 @end deffn
2131
2132 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2133 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2134 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2135 output from the Tcl engine.
2136 Intended as a machine interface.
2137 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2138 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2139
2140 @end deffn
2141
2142 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2143 Specify or query the
2144 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2145 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2146 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2147 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2148 When specified as zero, this port is not activated.
2149 @end deffn
2150
2151 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2152 @section GDB Configuration
2153 @cindex GDB
2154 @cindex GDB configuration
2155 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2156 The ones listed here are static and global.
2157 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2158 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2159
2160 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2161 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2162 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2163 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2164 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2165 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2166 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2167 @end deffn
2168
2169 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2170 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2171 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2172 vFlash packet is received.
2173 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2174 @end deffn
2175
2176 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2177 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2178 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2179 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2180 for flash programming to work.
2181 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2182 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2183 @end deffn
2184
2185 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2186 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2187 by GDB memory read packets.
2188 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2189 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2190 @end deffn
2191
2192 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2193 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2194 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
2195 @end deffn
2196
2197 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2198 Saves the target descripton file to the local file system.
2199
2200 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2201 @end deffn
2202
2203 @anchor{eventpolling}
2204 @section Event Polling
2205
2206 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2207 where significant events can happen at any time.
2208 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2209 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2210 or to GDB.
2211
2212 Examples of such events include:
2213
2214 @itemize
2215 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2216 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2217 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2218 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2219 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2220 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2221 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2222 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2223 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2224 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2225 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2226 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2227 @end itemize
2228
2229 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2230 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2231 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2232 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2233 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2234
2235 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2236 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2237 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2238 to the various active targets.
2239 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2240 which is normally done in the background.
2241
2242 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2243 Poll the current target for its current state.
2244 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2245 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2246 specific information about the current state is printed.
2247 An optional parameter
2248 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2249
2250 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2251 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2252 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2253 @example
2254 > poll
2255 background polling: on
2256 target state: halted
2257 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2258 current mode: Supervisor
2259 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2260 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2261 >
2262 @end example
2263 @end deffn
2264
2265 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2266 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2267 @cindex config file, interface
2268 @cindex interface config file
2269
2270 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2271 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2272 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2273
2274 @quotation Note
2275 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2276 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2277 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2278 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2279 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2280 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2281 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2282 @end quotation
2283
2284 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2285 through commands in an interface configuration
2286 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2287 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2288
2289 @example
2290 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2291 @end example
2292
2293 These commands tell
2294 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2295 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2296
2297 @example
2298 # jlink interface
2299 interface jlink
2300 @end example
2301
2302 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2303
2304
2305 @section Interface Configuration
2306
2307 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2308 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2309 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2310
2311 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2312 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2313 target.
2314 @end deffn
2315
2316 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2317 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2318 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2319 @end deffn
2320 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2321 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2322 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2323 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2324 the hardware can support.
2325 @end deffn
2326
2327
2328
2329 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2330 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2331 @end deffn
2332
2333 @section Interface Drivers
2334
2335 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2336 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2337 available at run time.
2338
2339 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2340 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2341 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2342 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2343
2344 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2345 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2346 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2347 @end deffn
2348
2349 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2350 Displays status of RTCK option.
2351 Optionally sets that option first.
2352 @end deffn
2353 @end deffn
2354
2355 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2356 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2357 This has one driver-specific command:
2358
2359 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2360 Logs some status
2361 @end deffn
2362 @end deffn
2363
2364 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2365 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2366 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2367 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2368 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2369 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2370 @end deffn
2371
2372 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2373 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2374
2375 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2376 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2377 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2378 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2379 @example
2380 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2381 @end example
2382 @end deffn
2383
2384 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2385 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2386 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2387 @end deffn
2388
2389 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2390 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2391 @end deffn
2392 @end deffn
2393
2394 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2395 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2396 @end deffn
2397
2398 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2399 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2400 @end deffn
2401
2402 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft2232}
2403 FTDI FT2232 (USB) based devices over one of the userspace libraries.
2404
2405 Note that this driver has several flaws and the @command{ftdi} driver is
2406 recommended as its replacement.
2407
2408 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2409 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2410
2411 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_device_desc} description
2412 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2413 of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not
2414 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2415 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2416 @end deffn
2417
2418 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_serial} serial-number
2419 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the FTDI FT2232 device to use,
2420 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one FT2232 device
2421 is connected to the host.
2422 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2423 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2424 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2425 @end deffn
2426
2427 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_layout} name
2428 Each vendor's FT2232 device can use different GPIO signals
2429 to control output-enables, reset signals, and LEDs.
2430 Currently valid layout @var{name} values include:
2431 @itemize @minus
2432 @item @b{axm0432_jtag} Axiom AXM-0432
2433 @item @b{comstick} Hitex STR9 comstick
2434 @item @b{cortino} Hitex Cortino JTAG interface
2435 @item @b{evb_lm3s811} TI/Luminary Micro EVB_LM3S811 as a JTAG interface,
2436 either for the local Cortex-M3 (SRST only)
2437 or in a passthrough mode (neither SRST nor TRST)
2438 This layout can not support the SWO trace mechanism, and should be
2439 used only for older boards (before rev C).
2440 @item @b{luminary_icdi} This layout should be used with most TI/Luminary
2441 eval boards, including Rev C LM3S811 eval boards and the eponymous
2442 ICDI boards, to debug either the local Cortex-M3 or in passthrough mode
2443 to debug some other target. It can support the SWO trace mechanism.
2444 @item @b{flyswatter} Tin Can Tools Flyswatter
2445 @item @b{icebear} ICEbear JTAG adapter from Section 5
2446 @item @b{jtagkey} Amontec JTAGkey and JTAGkey-Tiny (and compatibles)
2447 @item @b{jtagkey2} Amontec JTAGkey2 (and compatibles)
2448 @item @b{m5960} American Microsystems M5960
2449 @item @b{olimex-jtag} Olimex ARM-USB-OCD and ARM-USB-Tiny
2450 @item @b{oocdlink} OOCDLink
2451 @c oocdlink ~= jtagkey_prototype_v1
2452 @item @b{redbee-econotag} Integrated with a Redbee development board.
2453 @item @b{redbee-usb} Integrated with a Redbee USB-stick development board.
2454 @item @b{sheevaplug} Marvell Sheevaplug development kit
2455 @item @b{signalyzer} Xverve Signalyzer
2456 @item @b{stm32stick} Hitex STM32 Performance Stick
2457 @item @b{turtelizer2} egnite Software turtelizer2
2458 @item @b{usbjtag} "USBJTAG-1" layout described in the OpenOCD diploma thesis
2459 @end itemize
2460 @end deffn
2461
2462 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2463 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not specified, the FTDI
2464 default values are used.
2465 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2466 @example
2467 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2468 @end example
2469 @end deffn
2470
2471 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_latency} ms
2472 On some systems using FT2232 based JTAG interfaces the FT_Read function call in
2473 ft2232_read() fails to return the expected number of bytes. This can be caused by
2474 USB communication delays and has proved hard to reproduce and debug. Setting the
2475 FT2232 latency timer to a larger value increases delays for short USB packets but it
2476 also reduces the risk of timeouts before receiving the expected number of bytes.
2477 The OpenOCD default value is 2 and for some systems a value of 10 has proved useful.
2478 @end deffn
2479
2480 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_channel} channel
2481 Used to select the channel of the ft2232 chip to use (between 1 and 4).
2482 The default value is 1.
2483 @end deffn
2484
2485 For example, the interface config file for a
2486 Turtelizer JTAG Adapter looks something like this:
2487
2488 @example
2489 interface ft2232
2490 ft2232_device_desc "Turtelizer JTAG/RS232 Adapter"
2491 ft2232_layout turtelizer2
2492 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xbdc8
2493 @end example
2494 @end deffn
2495
2496 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2497 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2498 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2499 It is a complete rewrite to address a large number of problems with the ft2232
2500 interface driver.
2501
2502 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2503 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi of D2XX. Performance-wise it is
2504 consistently faster than the ft2232 driver, sometimes several times faster.
2505
2506 A major improvement of this driver is that support for new FTDI based adapters
2507 can be added competely through configuration files, without the need to patch
2508 and rebuild OpenOCD.
2509
2510 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2511 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2512 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2513 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2514 will be used for their customary purpose.
2515
2516 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2517 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2518 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2519 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2520
2521 @itemize @minus
2522 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2523 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2524 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2525 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2526 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2527 switching data and direction as necessary
2528 @end itemize
2529
2530 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2531 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2532
2533 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2534 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, the FTDI
2535 default values are used.
2536 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2537 @example
2538 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2539 @end example
2540 @end deffn
2541
2542 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2543 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2544 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2545 during device selection.
2546 @end deffn
2547
2548 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2549 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2550 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2551 is connected to the host.
2552 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2553 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2554 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2555 @end deffn
2556
2557 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2558 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2559 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2560 @end deffn
2561
2562 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2563 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2564 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2565 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2566 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2567 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2568 and initially asserted reset signals.
2569 @end deffn
2570
2571 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2572 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2573 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2574 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2575 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2576 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2577 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2578 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2579 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected.
2580
2581 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2582 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2583 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2584 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2585 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2586 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2587
2588 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2589 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2590 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2591 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2592 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2593 are always driven by the FTDI.
2594
2595 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2596 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2597 @var{name}.
2598 @end deffn
2599
2600 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2601 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2602 @itemize @minus
2603 @item @option{0}, drive low
2604 @item @option{1}, drive high
2605 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2606 @end itemize
2607 @end deffn
2608
2609 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2610 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2611 @end deffn
2612
2613 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2614 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2615 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2616 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2617
2618 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2619 processors which are being simulated.
2620
2621 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2622 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2623 sockets instead of TCP.
2624 @end deffn
2625
2626 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2627 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2628 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2629 @end deffn
2630
2631 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2632 something like:
2633
2634 @example
2635 interface remote_bitbang
2636 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2637 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2638 @end example
2639
2640 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2641 named mysocket:
2642
2643 @example
2644 interface remote_bitbang
2645 remote_bitbang_port 0
2646 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2647 @end example
2648 @end deffn
2649
2650 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2651 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2652 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2653 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2654
2655 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2656 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2657 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2658 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2659 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2660 @end deffn
2661
2662 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2663 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2664 default values are used.
2665 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2666 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2667 @example
2668 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2669 @end example
2670 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2671 @example
2672 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2673 @end example
2674 @end deffn
2675
2676 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1})
2677 Sets the state of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters (pins 6 and 8 on the
2678 female JTAG header). These pins can be used as SRST and/or TRST provided the
2679 appropriate connections are made on the target board.
2680
2681 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST (as with an AVR board):
2682 @example
2683 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-assert \
2684 "usb_blaster pin6 1; wait 1; usb_blaster pin6 0"
2685 @end example
2686 @end deffn
2687
2688 @end deffn
2689
2690 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2691 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2692 This has one driver-specific command:
2693
2694 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2695 Display either the address of the I/O port
2696 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2697 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2698 This is a write-once setting.
2699 @end deffn
2700 @end deffn
2701
2702 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2703 Segger J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD transports.
2704
2705 @quotation Compatibility Note
2706 Segger released many firmware versions for the many harware versions they
2707 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2708 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2709 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2710 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2711 target, and Segger firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2712 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2713 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2714 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2715 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2716 @end quotation
2717
2718 @deffn {Command} {jlink caps}
2719 Display the device firmware capabilities.
2720 @end deffn
2721 @deffn {Command} {jlink info}
2722 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2723 @end deffn
2724 @deffn {Command} {jlink hw_jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2725 Set the JTAG protocol version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG protocol version.
2726 @end deffn
2727 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2728 Display the J-Link configuration.
2729 @end deffn
2730 @deffn {Command} {jlink config kickstart} [val]
2731 Set the Kickstart power on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the Kickstart configuration.
2732 @end deffn
2733 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac_address} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2734 Set the MAC address of the J-Link Pro. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2735 @end deffn
2736 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2737 Set the IP configuration of the J-Link Pro, where A.B.C.D is the IP address,
2738 E the bit of the subnet mask and
2739 F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the IP configuration.
2740 @end deffn
2741 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb_address} [@option{0x00} to @option{0x03} or @option{0xff}]
2742 Set the USB address; this will also change the product id. Without argument, show the USB address.
2743 @end deffn
2744 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2745 Reset the current configuration.
2746 @end deffn
2747 @deffn {Command} {jlink config save}
2748 Save the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2749 @end deffn
2750 @deffn {Config} {jlink pid} val
2751 Set the USB PID of the interface. As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2752 @end deffn
2753 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} serial-number
2754 Set the @var{serial-number} of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected to the host.
2755 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2756
2757 Note that there may be leading zeros in the @var{serial-number} string
2758 that will not show in the Segger software, but must be specified here.
2759 Debug level 3 output contains serial numbers if there is a mismatch.
2760
2761 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2762 @end deffn
2763 @end deffn
2764
2765 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2766 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2767 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2768 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2769 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2770
2771 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2772 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2773 This is a write-once setting.
2774 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2775
2776 @itemize @minus
2777 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2778 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2779 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2780 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2781 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2782 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2783 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2784 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2785 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2786 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2787 some versions of
2788 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2789 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2790 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2791 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2792 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2793 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2794 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2795 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2796 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2797 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2798 @end itemize
2799 @end deffn
2800
2801 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2802 Display either the address of the I/O port
2803 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2804 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2805 This is a write-once setting.
2806
2807 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2808 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2809 you may encounter a problem.
2810 @end deffn
2811
2812 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2813 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2814 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2815 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2816 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2817 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2818
2819 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2820 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2821 @quotation Tip
2822 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2823 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2824 @example
2825 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2826 > adapter_khz 500
2827 @end example
2828 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2829 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2830 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2831 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2832 large set of samples.
2833 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2834 @example
2835 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2836 @end example
2837 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
2838 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2839
2840 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2841 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2842 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2843 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2844 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
2845 @end quotation
2846 @end deffn
2847
2848 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
2849 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
2850 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
2851 @end deffn
2852
2853 For example, the interface configuration file for a
2854 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
2855
2856 @example
2857 interface parport
2858 parport_port 0x278
2859 parport_cable wiggler
2860 @end example
2861 @end deffn
2862
2863 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
2864 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
2865 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
2866 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
2867 @end deffn
2868 @end deffn
2869
2870 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
2871 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
2872 @end deffn
2873
2874 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
2875 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2876 @end deffn
2877
2878 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
2879 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
2880
2881 @quotation Note
2882 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
2883 which are not currently documented here.
2884 @end quotation
2885 @end deffn
2886
2887 @anchor{hla_interface}
2888 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
2889 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
2890 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
2891 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
2892
2893 Currently supported adapters include the ST STLINK and TI ICDI.
2894 STLINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
2895 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
2896 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade STLINK firmware even if current
2897 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
2898
2899 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
2900 Currently Not Supported.
2901 @end deffn
2902
2903 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
2904 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
2905 @end deffn
2906
2907 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
2908 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
2909 @end deffn
2910
2911 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} vid pid
2912 The vendor ID and product ID of the device.
2913 @end deffn
2914
2915 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
2916 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
2917 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
2918 @end deffn
2919 @end deffn
2920
2921 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
2922 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2923 @end deffn
2924
2925 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
2926 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
2927 @end deffn
2928
2929 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
2930 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
2931 @end deffn
2932
2933 @quotation Note
2934 This defines some driver-specific commands,
2935 which are not currently documented here.
2936 @end quotation
2937
2938 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2939 Turn power switch to target on/off.
2940 No arguments: print status.
2941 @end deffn
2942
2943 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
2944 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
2945 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
2946
2947 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
2948 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
2949 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
2950 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
2951 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
2952 configuration on exit.
2953
2954 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
2955 pinout.
2956
2957 @end deffn
2958
2959 @section Transport Configuration
2960 @cindex Transport
2961 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
2962 and the debug adapter you are using,
2963 several transports may be available to
2964 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
2965 @deffn Command {transport list}
2966 displays the names of the transports supported by this
2967 version of OpenOCD.
2968 @end deffn
2969
2970 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
2971 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
2972
2973 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
2974 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
2975 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
2976 adapter's driver).
2977
2978 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
2979 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
2980 supported by the debug adapter.
2981
2982 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
2983 transport, if any.
2984 @end deffn
2985
2986 @subsection JTAG Transport
2987 @cindex JTAG
2988 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
2989 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
2990 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
2991 each of which must be explicitly declared.
2992 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
2993 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
2994
2995 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
2996 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
2997 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
2998 hla_jtag}.
2999
3000 @subsection SWD Transport
3001 @cindex SWD
3002 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3003 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3004 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3005 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3006 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3007 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3008 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3009
3010 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3011 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3012 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3013 hla_swd}.
3014
3015 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3016 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3017 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3018 expected to change.
3019 @end deffn
3020 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3021 Updates TRN (turnaraound delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3022 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3023 No parameters: displays current settings.
3024 @end deffn
3025
3026 @subsection SPI Transport
3027 @cindex SPI
3028 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3029 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3030 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3031 solution for flash programming.
3032
3033 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3034 @section JTAG Speed
3035 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3036 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3037 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3038 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3039 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3040 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3041 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3042 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3043 power management software that may be active.
3044
3045 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3046 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3047 target event handler.
3048 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3049 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3050 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3051 sets up those clocks).
3052 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3053 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3054 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3055 in the target config file.
3056 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3057 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3058 config file instead.
3059 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3060 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3061 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3062
3063 @example
3064 jtag_rclk 3000
3065 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3066 @end example
3067
3068 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3069 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3070 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3071 may not be the fastest solution.
3072
3073 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3074 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3075 which support adaptive clocking.
3076
3077 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3078 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3079 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3080 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3081 than the speed specified.
3082
3083 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3084 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3085 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3086 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3087
3088 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3089 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3090 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3091 JTAG clocking after setup.
3092 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3093 If the interface device can not
3094 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3095 @end deffn
3096
3097 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3098 @cindex adaptive clocking
3099 @cindex RTCK
3100 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3101 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3102 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3103 @example
3104 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3105 jtag_rclk 3000
3106 @end example
3107 @end defun
3108
3109 @node Reset Configuration
3110 @chapter Reset Configuration
3111 @cindex Reset Configuration
3112
3113 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3114 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3115 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3116 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3117 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3118 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3119 Please see the various board files for examples.
3120
3121 @quotation Note
3122 To maintainers and integrators:
3123 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3124 Normally the board configuration file
3125 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3126 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3127
3128 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3129 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3130 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3131 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3132 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3133 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3134 @end quotation
3135
3136 @section Types of Reset
3137
3138 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3139 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3140 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3141
3142 @itemize @bullet
3143 @item
3144 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3145 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3146 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3147 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3148 @item
3149 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3150 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3151 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3152 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3153 @item
3154 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3155 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3156 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3157 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3158 @item
3159 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3160 several other types of reset.
3161 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3162 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3163 There may be individual module resets.
3164 @end itemize
3165
3166 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3167 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3168 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3169 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3170 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3171 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3172 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3173 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3174 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3175
3176 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3177 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3178
3179 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3180 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3181 common issues are:
3182
3183 @itemize @bullet
3184
3185 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3186 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3187 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3188 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3189 when either of those signals is not connected.
3190 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3191 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3192 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3193 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3194
3195 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3196 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3197 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3198 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3199
3200 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3201 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3202 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3203 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3204 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3205 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3206 hardware debouncing.
3207 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3208 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3209
3210 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3211 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3212 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3213 to use push/pull output drivers.
3214 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3215 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3216 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3217 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3218
3219 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3220 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3221 issues (not limited to errata).
3222 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3223 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3224 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3225 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3226 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3227 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3228 @end itemize
3229
3230 There can also be other issues.
3231 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3232 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3233 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3234 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3235 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3236 Agreement (NDA).
3237
3238 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3239 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3240 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3241
3242 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3243 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3244
3245 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3246
3247 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3248 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3249 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3250 allowing it to be deasserted.
3251 @end deffn
3252
3253 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3254 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3255 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3256 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3257 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3258 @end deffn
3259
3260 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3261 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3262 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3263 allowing it to be deasserted.
3264 @end deffn
3265
3266 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3267 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3268 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3269 @end deffn
3270
3271 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3272 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3273 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3274 configuration scripts.
3275
3276 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3277 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3278 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3279 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3280 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3281 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3282 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3283 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3284
3285 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3286 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3287 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3288 -- may be specified at a time.
3289 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3290 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3291 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3292 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3293 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3294
3295 @itemize
3296 @item
3297 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3298 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3299 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3300 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3301 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3302
3303 @quotation Tip
3304 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3305 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3306 @end quotation
3307
3308 @item
3309 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3310 signal implementations.
3311 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3312 indicating everything behaves normally.
3313 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3314 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3315 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3316 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3317 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3318 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3319 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3320
3321 @item
3322 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3323 JTAG may be unvailable during reset.
3324 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3325 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3326 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3327 while SRST is asserted.
3328 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3329 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3330
3331 @item
3332 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3333 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3334 is required to use this option.
3335 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3336 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3337 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3338 be asserted before any target connection.
3339 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3340 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3341 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3342 @end itemize
3343
3344 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3345 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3346 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3347 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3348 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3349
3350 @itemize
3351 @item
3352 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3353 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3354 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3355 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3356
3357 @item
3358 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3359 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3360 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3361 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3362 powerup and pressing a reset button.
3363 @end itemize
3364 @end deffn
3365
3366 @section Custom Reset Handling
3367 @cindex events
3368
3369 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3370 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3371 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3372 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3373 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3374 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3375
3376 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3377 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3378 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3379 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3380 want to reset everything at once.
3381
3382 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3383 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3384 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3385 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3386 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3387 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3388 needs special attention.
3389
3390 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3391 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3392 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3393 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3394 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3395 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3396 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3397 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3398
3399 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3400 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3401 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3402 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3403 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3404
3405 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3406 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3407 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3408 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3409 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3410 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3411 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3412 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3413 or potentially some other value.
3414
3415 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3416 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3417 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3418 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3419 (or their associated targets)
3420 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3421
3422 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3423 they return.
3424 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3425 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3426 @end deffn
3427
3428 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3429 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3430 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3431 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3432 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3433 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3434 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3435 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3436 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3437 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3438 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3439 @end deffn
3440
3441 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3442 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3443 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3444 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3445 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3446 @end deffn
3447
3448
3449 @node TAP Declaration
3450 @chapter TAP Declaration
3451 @cindex TAP declaration
3452 @cindex TAP configuration
3453
3454 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3455 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3456
3457 @itemize @bullet
3458 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3459 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3460 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3461 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3462 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3463 start running that code.
3464 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3465 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3466 and missing connections.
3467 @end itemize
3468
3469 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3470 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3471 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3472 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3473 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3474
3475 @section Scan Chains
3476 @cindex scan chain
3477
3478 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3479 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3480 They also need to be added to
3481 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3482 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3483 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3484 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3485 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3486 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3487 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3488 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3489
3490 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3491 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3492 command, presented in the next chapter.
3493 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3494 debugging targets.)
3495 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3496
3497 @verbatim
3498 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3499 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3500 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3501 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3502 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3503 @end verbatim
3504
3505 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3506 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3507 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3508 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3509 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3510 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3511 until they are told to do so.
3512
3513 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3514 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3515 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3516 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3517
3518 @example
3519 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3520 @end example
3521
3522 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3523 by a given chip.
3524 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3525 and so forth.
3526 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3527 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3528 both inside a single chip and between them.
3529 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3530
3531 For example, the ST Microsystems STR912 chip has
3532 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3533 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3534 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3535 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3536 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3537 includes commands something like this:
3538
3539 @example
3540 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3541 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3542 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3543 @end example
3544
3545 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3546 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3547 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3548
3549 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3550 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3551 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3552 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3553 @example
3554 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3555 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3556 @}
3557 @end example
3558 @end deffn
3559
3560 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3561 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3562 and their status.
3563 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3564 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3565 but systems with a JTAG router can
3566 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3567 @end deffn
3568
3569 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3570 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3571
3572 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3573 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3574
3575 @section TAP Names
3576 @cindex dotted name
3577
3578 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3579 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3580 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3581 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3582 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3583 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3584 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3585 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3586
3587 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3588 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3589 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3590
3591 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3592
3593 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3594 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3595 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3596 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3597
3598 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3599 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3600 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3601 overridable.
3602
3603 @cindex TAP naming convention
3604 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3605 and should follow this convention:
3606
3607 @itemize @bullet
3608 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3609 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3610 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3611 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3612 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3613 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3614 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3615 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3616 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3617 with a single TAP;
3618 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3619 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3620 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3621 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3622 @end itemize
3623
3624 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3625
3626 @itemize @bullet
3627 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3628 @*The length in bits of the
3629 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3630 @end itemize
3631
3632 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3633
3634 @itemize @bullet
3635 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3636 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3637 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3638 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3639 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3640 (the TAP is linked in).
3641 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3642 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3643 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3644 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3645 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3646 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3647 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3648 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3649 values that were found but not included in the list.
3650
3651 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3652 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3653 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3654 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3655 hardware to find these values.
3656 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3657 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3658 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3659 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3660 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3661 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3662 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3663 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3664 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3665 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3666 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3667 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3668 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3669 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3670 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3671 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3672 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3673 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3674 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3675 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3676 @end itemize
3677 @end deffn
3678
3679 @section Other TAP commands
3680
3681 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3682 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3683 At this writing this TAP attribute
3684 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3685 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3686 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3687 See the next section for information about the available events.
3688
3689 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3690 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3691 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3692 @end deffn
3693
3694 @section TAP Events
3695 @cindex events
3696 @cindex TAP events
3697
3698 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3699 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3700 The other applies to debugger targets,
3701 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3702
3703 The TAP events currently defined are:
3704
3705 @itemize @bullet
3706 @item @b{post-reset}
3707 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3708 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3709 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3710 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3711 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3712
3713 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3714 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3715 of any particular target.
3716 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3717 @item @b{setup}
3718 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3719 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3720 @item @b{tap-disable}
3721 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3722 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3723 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3724 @item @b{tap-enable}
3725 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3726 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3727 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3728 @end itemize
3729
3730 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3731 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3732 contents to be accurate), you might:
3733
3734 @example
3735 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3736 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3737 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3738 @}
3739 @end example
3740
3741
3742 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3743 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3744 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3745 @cindex jrc
3746
3747 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3748 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3749 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3750 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3751 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3752
3753 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3754 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3755 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3756 be visible.
3757 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3758 ignores, such as:
3759
3760 @itemize
3761 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3762 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3763 TAPs receive new instructions.
3764 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3765 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3766 @end itemize
3767
3768 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3769 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3770 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3771 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3772
3773 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3774 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3775
3776 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3777 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3778 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3779 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3780 should define TAP event handlers using
3781 code that looks something like this:
3782
3783 @example
3784 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3785 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3786 @}
3787 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3788 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3789 @}
3790 @end example
3791
3792 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3793
3794 @example
3795 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3796 @end example
3797
3798 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
3799 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
3800 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
3801 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
3802
3803 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
3804 If necessary, disables the tap
3805 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
3806 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3807 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3808 and "0" if it is disabled.
3809 @end deffn
3810
3811 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
3812 If necessary, enables the tap
3813 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
3814 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3815 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3816 and "0" if it is disabled.
3817 @end deffn
3818
3819 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
3820 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3821 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3822 and "0" if it is disabled.
3823
3824 @quotation Note
3825 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
3826 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
3827 @end quotation
3828 @end deffn
3829
3830 @anchor{autoprobing}
3831 @section Autoprobing
3832 @cindex autoprobe
3833 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
3834
3835 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
3836 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
3837 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
3838 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
3839
3840 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
3841 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
3842 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
3843 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
3844 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
3845 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
3846 right when they come out of reset).
3847
3848 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
3849
3850 @example
3851 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
3852 reset_config trst_and_srst
3853 jtag_rclk 8
3854 @end example
3855
3856 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
3857 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
3858
3859 @enumerate
3860 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
3861 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
3862 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
3863 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
3864 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
3865 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
3866 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
3867 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
3868 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
3869 that is discovered.
3870 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
3871 register, it will report it.
3872 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
3873 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
3874 @end enumerate
3875
3876 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
3877 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
3878 that's a bit more complex:
3879
3880 @example
3881 clock speed 8 kHz
3882 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
3883 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
3884 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
3885 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
3886 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3887 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3888 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
3889 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
3890 @end example
3891
3892 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
3893 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
3894 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
3895 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
3896 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
3897 and so forth.
3898
3899 @node CPU Configuration
3900 @chapter CPU Configuration
3901 @cindex GDB target
3902
3903 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
3904 You can also access these targets without GDB
3905 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
3906 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
3907 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
3908 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
3909
3910 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
3911 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
3912
3913 @section Target List
3914 @cindex target, current
3915 @cindex target, list
3916
3917 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
3918 where each member has a name.
3919 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
3920 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
3921 (plural!) command.
3922 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
3923 look like with more than one:
3924 @verbatim
3925 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
3926 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
3927 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
3928 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
3929 @end verbatim
3930
3931 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
3932 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
3933 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
3934 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
3935 space seen by that current target.
3936 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
3937 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
3938 are examples; and there are many more.
3939
3940 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
3941
3942 @deffn Command {target current}
3943 Returns the name of the current target.
3944 @end deffn
3945
3946 @deffn Command {target names}
3947 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
3948 @example
3949 foreach t [target names] @{
3950 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
3951 @}
3952 @end example
3953 @end deffn
3954
3955 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
3956 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
3957
3958 @deffn Command targets [name]
3959 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
3960 command names are singular.}
3961
3962 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
3963 targets in a user friendly form.
3964
3965 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
3966 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
3967 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
3968 @end deffn
3969
3970 @section Target CPU Types
3971 @cindex target type
3972 @cindex CPU type
3973
3974 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
3975 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
3976 when calling @command{target create}.
3977 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
3978 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
3979 what kind of debug support it integrates,
3980 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
3981 what core-specific commands may be available
3982 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
3983 and more.
3984
3985 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
3986 since there's a command to list them.
3987
3988 @anchor{targettypes}
3989 @deffn Command {target types}
3990 Lists all supported target types.
3991 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
3992
3993 @itemize @bullet
3994 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
3995 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
3996 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
3997 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
3998 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
3999 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4000 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4001 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4002 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4003 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4004 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4005 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4006 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4007 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4008 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4009 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4010 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4011 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4012 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4013 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4014 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4015 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4016 @itemize @minus
4017 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
4018 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4019 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4020 @end itemize
4021 And two debug interfaces cores:
4022 @itemize @minus
4023 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4024 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4025 @end itemize
4026 @end itemize
4027 @end deffn
4028
4029 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4030 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4031 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4032 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4033 licenced, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4034 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4035 reflect design generations;
4036 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, and ARMv7
4037 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4038
4039 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4040 @section Target Configuration
4041
4042 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4043 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4044 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4045 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4046 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4047
4048 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4049 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4050 optional parts.
4051 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4052 command, created as part of target creation.
4053
4054 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4055 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4056 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4057 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4058 to be much more board-specific.
4059 The key steps you use might look something like this
4060
4061 @example
4062 target create MyTarget cortex_m -chain-position mychip.cpu
4063 $MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4064 $MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4065 $MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4066 @end example
4067
4068 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4069 on-chip SRAM.
4070 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4071 writes to target memory;
4072 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4073 GDB memory checksumming;
4074 and more.
4075
4076 @quotation Warning
4077 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4078 inaccessible when application code
4079 (such as an operating system)
4080 enables or disables the MMU.
4081 For example, the particular MMU context used to acess the virtual
4082 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4083 easy access to other addresses needed.
4084 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4085 @end quotation
4086
4087 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4088 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4089 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4090 controllers.
4091 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4092 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4093 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4094
4095 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4096 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4097 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4098 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4099 purposes including additional configuration.
4100
4101 @itemize @bullet
4102 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4103 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4104 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4105 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4106
4107 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4108 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4109 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4110 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4111 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4112 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4113 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4114
4115 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} here.
4116 @end itemize
4117 @end deffn
4118
4119 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4120 The options accepted by this command may also be
4121 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4122 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4123 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4124
4125 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4126 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4127 and changing its endianness.
4128
4129 @itemize @bullet
4130
4131 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4132 used to access this target.
4133
4134 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4135 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4136
4137 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4138 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4139 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4140 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4141 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4142 same event name assigns only one handler.
4143
4144 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4145 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4146 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4147 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4148 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4149 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4150 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4151
4152 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4153 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4154 or virtual address is being used.
4155
4156 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4157 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4158
4159 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4160 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4161 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4162 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4163 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4164
4165 @anchor{rtostype}
4166 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4167 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}|@option{eCos}|@option{ThreadX}|
4168 @option{FreeRTOS}|@option{linux}|@option{ChibiOS}|@option{embKernel}|@option{mqx}
4169 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4170
4171 @end itemize
4172 @end deffn
4173
4174 @section Other $target_name Commands
4175 @cindex object command
4176
4177 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4178 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4179
4180 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4181 Once a button is created a button
4182 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4183 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4184 configure it like this:
4185
4186 @example
4187 # Create
4188 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4189 # Modify
4190 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4191 # Query
4192 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4193 # Report
4194 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4195 @end example
4196
4197 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4198 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4199
4200 @example
4201 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4202 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4203 @end example
4204
4205 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4206
4207 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine}
4208 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4209 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4210 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4211 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4212 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4213 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4214 They are not otherwise documented here.
4215 @end deffn
4216
4217 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4218 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4219 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4220 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4221 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4222 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4223 the target side uses raw memory.
4224
4225 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4226 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4227 The script orientation comes from working with data
4228 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4229 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4230 and neither store nor return those values.
4231
4232 @itemize
4233 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4234 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4235 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4236 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4237 @end itemize
4238 @end deffn
4239
4240 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4241 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4242 @command{$target_name configure}
4243 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4244 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4245 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4246 There are a few special cases:
4247
4248 @itemize @bullet
4249 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4250 event named @var{event_name}.
4251 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4252 two parameters.
4253 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4254 This is a special case because this is set using
4255 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4256 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4257 @end itemize
4258
4259 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4260 all the targets you might use something like this:
4261
4262 @example
4263 foreach name [target names] @{
4264 set y [$name cget -endian]
4265 set z [$name cget -type]
4266 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4267 $x $name $y $z]
4268 @}
4269 @end example
4270 @end deffn
4271
4272 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4273 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4274 Displays the current target state:
4275 @code{debug-running},
4276 @code{halted},
4277 @code{reset},
4278 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4279 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4280 @end deffn
4281
4282 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4283 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4284 currently associated with this target.
4285 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4286 @end deffn
4287
4288 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4289 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4290 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4291 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4292 @end deffn
4293
4294 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4295 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4296 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4297 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4298 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4299 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4300 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4301 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4302 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4303 @end deffn
4304
4305 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4306 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4307 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4308 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4309 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4310 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4311 @end deffn
4312
4313 @anchor{targetevents}
4314 @section Target Events
4315 @cindex target events
4316 @cindex events
4317 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4318 For example:
4319 @itemize @bullet
4320 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4321 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4322 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4323 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4324 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4325 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4326 to set up system clocks or
4327 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4328 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4329 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4330 @end itemize
4331
4332 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4333 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4334 @command{target create ... -event}.
4335
4336 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4337 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4338 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4339
4340 @example
4341 proc my_attach_proc @{ @} @{
4342 echo "Reset..."
4343 reset halt
4344 @}
4345 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach my_attach_proc
4346 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach @{
4347 echo "Reset..."
4348 # To make flash probe and gdb load to flash work
4349 # we need a reset init.
4350 reset init
4351 @}
4352 @end example
4353
4354 The following target events are defined:
4355
4356 @itemize @bullet
4357 @item @b{debug-halted}
4358 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4359 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4360 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: gdb said run)
4361 @item @b{early-halted}
4362 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4363 @item @b{examine-start}
4364 @* Before target examine is called.
4365 @item @b{examine-end}
4366 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4367 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4368 @* When GDB connects. This is before any communication with the target, so this
4369 can be used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash. Probing flash
4370 is necessary during gdb connect if gdb load is to write the image to flash. Another
4371 use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically hardware/software breakpoints
4372 depending on whether the breakpoint is in RAM or read only memory.
4373 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4374 @* When GDB disconnects
4375 @item @b{gdb-end}
4376 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4377 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4378 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4379 @code{reset init})
4380 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4381 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4382 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4383 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4384 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4385 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4386 @item @b{gdb-start}
4387 @* Before the target steps, gdb is trying to start/resume the target
4388 @item @b{halted}
4389 @* The target has halted
4390 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4391 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4392 after @command{reset_init} was triggered
4393 but before either SRST alone is re-asserted on the scan chain,
4394 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4395 @item @b{reset-assert}
4396 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4397 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4398 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4399 it instead of asserting SRST.
4400 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4401 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4402 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4403 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4404 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4405 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4406 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4407 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4408 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4409 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4410 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4411 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4412 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4413 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4414 released on the scan chain.
4415 @item @b{reset-end}
4416 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4417 @ignore
4418 @item @b{reset-halt-post}
4419 @* Currently not used
4420 @item @b{reset-halt-pre}
4421 @* Currently not used
4422 @end ignore
4423 @item @b{reset-init}
4424 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4425 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4426
4427 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4428 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4429 multiplexing, and so on.
4430 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4431 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4432 @item @b{reset-start}
4433 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4434 before @command{reset_init} is called.
4435
4436 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4437 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4438 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4439 @ignore
4440 @item @b{reset-wait-pos}
4441 @* Currently not used
4442 @item @b{reset-wait-pre}
4443 @* Currently not used
4444 @end ignore
4445 @item @b{resume-start}
4446 @* Before any target is resumed
4447 @item @b{resume-end}
4448 @* After all targets have resumed
4449 @item @b{resumed}
4450 @* Target has resumed
4451 @item @b{trace-config}
4452 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4453 @end itemize
4454
4455 @node Flash Commands
4456 @chapter Flash Commands
4457
4458 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4459 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4460 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4461 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4462 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4463 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4464 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4465 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4466 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4467
4468 Flash Steps:
4469 @enumerate
4470 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4471 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4472 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4473 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4474 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4475 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4476 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4477 @item GDB Flashing
4478 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4479 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4480 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4481 @end enumerate
4482
4483 Many CPUs have the ablity to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4484 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4485 so that it can't boot.
4486 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4487 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4488
4489 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4490 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4491 @cindex flash configuration
4492
4493 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4494 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4495 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4496 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4497 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4498 see the driver-specific documentation.
4499
4500 @itemize @bullet
4501 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4502 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4503 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4504 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4505 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4506 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4507 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4508 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4509 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4510 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4511 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4512 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4513 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4514 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4515 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4516 commands to the flash controller.
4517 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4518 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4519 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4520 for more information.
4521 @end itemize
4522 @quotation Note
4523 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4524 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4525 @end quotation
4526 @end deffn
4527
4528 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4529 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4530 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4531 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4532 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4533 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4534 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4535 @end deffn
4536
4537 @deffn Command {flash list}
4538 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4539 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4540 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4541 @end deffn
4542
4543 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4544 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4545 depends on the flash type.
4546 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4547 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4548 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4549 but most don't bother.
4550 @end deffn
4551
4552 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4553 @cindex flash erasing
4554 @cindex flash reading
4555 @cindex flash writing
4556 @cindex flash programming
4557 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4558
4559 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4560 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressible memory.
4561 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4562 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4563 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4564
4565 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4566 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4567 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4568 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4569 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4570
4571 @quotation Note
4572 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4573 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4574 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4575 back to a flash bank.
4576 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4577 @comment with that target doesn't succesfuly autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4578 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4579 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4580 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4581 @end quotation
4582
4583 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4584 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4585 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4586 disabled first.
4587 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4588 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4589 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4590
4591 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4592 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4593 up to and including @var{last}.
4594 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4595 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4596 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4597 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4598 @end deffn
4599
4600 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4601 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4602 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4603 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4604 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4605 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4606 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4607 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4608 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4609 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4610 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4611 before erase starts.
4612 @end deffn
4613
4614 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4615 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4616 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4617 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4618 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4619 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4620 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4621 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4622 before issuing this command.
4623 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4624 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4625 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4626 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4627 @end deffn
4628 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4629
4630 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename offset
4631 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
4632 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
4633 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4634 @end deffn
4635
4636 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
4637 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
4638 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
4639 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
4640 to the base address for each section in the image.
4641 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
4642 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
4643 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
4644 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
4645 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
4646 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
4647 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
4648 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
4649 each image section.
4650
4651 @quotation Warning
4652 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
4653 data you want to preserve.
4654 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
4655 sections might be erased with no notice.
4656 @itemize
4657 @item
4658 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
4659 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
4660 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
4661 @item
4662 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
4663 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
4664 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
4665 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
4666 @end itemize
4667 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
4668 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
4669 @end quotation
4670
4671 @end deffn
4672
4673 @section Other Flash commands
4674 @cindex flash protection
4675
4676 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
4677 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
4678 and display that status.
4679 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4680 @end deffn
4681
4682 @deffn Command {flash info} num
4683 Print info about flash bank @var{num}
4684 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4685 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
4686 and possibly stale information.
4687 @end deffn
4688
4689 @anchor{flashprotect}
4690 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
4691 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash sectors
4692 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4693 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
4694 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4695 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4696 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4697 @end deffn
4698
4699 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
4700 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
4701 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
4702 comamnd or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
4703 @end deffn
4704
4705 @anchor{program}
4706 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
4707 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
4708 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
4709 @xref{Flash Programming}.
4710 @end deffn
4711
4712 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
4713 @section Flash Driver List
4714 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
4715 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
4716 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
4717
4718 @subsection External Flash
4719
4720 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
4721 @cindex Common Flash Interface
4722 @cindex CFI
4723 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
4724 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
4725 specific external chip select on the CPU.
4726 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
4727 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
4728 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
4729 configure a bus and its timings), or
4730 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
4731 on the flash chip.
4732 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
4733 speed up operation.
4734
4735 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
4736
4737 @itemize
4738 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
4739 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
4740 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
4741 @end itemize
4742
4743 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
4744 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
4745
4746 @example
4747 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4748 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4749 @end example
4750
4751 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
4752 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
4753 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
4754
4755 @example
4756 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
4757 @end example
4758
4759 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
4760 @end deffn
4761
4762 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
4763 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
4764 @cindex SPIFI
4765 @cindex lpcspifi
4766 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
4767 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
4768 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
4769
4770 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
4771 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
4772 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
4773 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
4774 significantly reduce flash programming times.
4775
4776 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
4777 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
4778 are configured by the driver.
4779
4780 @example
4781 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4782 @end example
4783
4784 @end deffn
4785
4786 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
4787 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
4788 @cindex SMI
4789 @cindex stmsmi
4790 Some devices form STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
4791 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
4792 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
4793 SPI flash devices.
4794 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
4795 flash devices can be connected.
4796
4797 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
4798 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
4799 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
4800 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
4801 the flash content.
4802
4803 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
4804 to identify the memory bank.
4805 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
4806 flash size, are detected automatically.
4807
4808 @example
4809 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4810 @end example
4811
4812 @end deffn
4813
4814 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
4815
4816 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
4817 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
4818 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
4819 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
4820 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
4821 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
4822
4823 @example
4824 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4825 @end example
4826 @end deffn
4827
4828 @anchor{at91samd}
4829 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
4830 @cindex at91samd
4831
4832 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
4833 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
4834 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
4835 processor to be halted.
4836 @end deffn
4837
4838 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
4839 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
4840 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
4841 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
4842 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
4843 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
4844
4845 @example
4846 at91samd set-security enable
4847 @end example
4848 @end deffn
4849
4850 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
4851 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
4852 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
4853 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
4854 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
4855 requires additional firmware support and the minumum EEPROM size may not be
4856 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
4857 in order to disable this feature.
4858
4859 @example
4860 at91samd eeprom
4861 at91samd eeprom 1024
4862 @end example
4863 @end deffn
4864
4865 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
4866 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
4867 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
4868 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
4869 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
4870 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
4871
4872 @example
4873 at91samd bootloader
4874 at91samd bootloader 16384
4875 @end example
4876 @end deffn
4877
4878 @end deffn
4879
4880 @anchor{at91sam3}
4881 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
4882 @cindex at91sam3
4883 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
4884 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
4885 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
4886 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
4887 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
4888 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
4889 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrysome comment after other
4890 chips are confirmed.}
4891
4892 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
4893 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
4894 the following fixed locations:
4895
4896 @example
4897 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
4898 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
4899 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
4900 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
4901 @end example
4902
4903 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
4904 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
4905 to the @command{flash bank} command:
4906
4907 @itemize
4908 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
4909 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
4910 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
4911 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
4912 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
4913 @end itemize
4914
4915 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
4916
4917 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
4918 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
4919 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
4920 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
4921 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
4922 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
4923 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
4924
4925 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
4926 modifies that GPNVM bit.
4927 @end deffn
4928
4929 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
4930 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
4931 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
4932 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
4933 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
4934 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
4935 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
4936 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
4937 @end deffn
4938
4939 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
4940 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
4941 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
4942 @end deffn
4943 @end deffn
4944
4945 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
4946 @cindex at91sam4
4947 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
4948 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
4949 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
4950 @end deffn
4951
4952 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
4953 @cindex at91sam4l
4954 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
4955 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
4956 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
4957
4958 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
4959 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
4960 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
4961 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
4962 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
4963 @end deffn
4964 @end deffn
4965
4966 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
4967 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
4968 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
4969 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
4970 register, and autoconfigures itself.
4971
4972 @example
4973 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4974 @end example
4975
4976 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
4977 provide additional parameters in the following order:
4978
4979 @itemize
4980 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
4981 @item @var{banks}
4982 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
4983 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
4984 @item @var{pages_size}
4985 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
4986 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
4987 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
4988 @end itemize
4989
4990 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
4991 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
4992 will be autoconfigured.
4993 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
4994
4995 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
4996 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
4997 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
4998 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
4999 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5000
5001 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5002 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5003 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5004 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5005 are not truly general purpose).
5006 @quotation Note
5007 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5008 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5009 @end quotation
5010 @end deffn
5011 @end deffn
5012
5013 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5014 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5015 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5016 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5017 @end deffn
5018
5019 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5020 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5021 internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5022 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5023 autoconfigures itself.
5024 @example
5025 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5026 @end example
5027 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5028 supported.}
5029 @end deffn
5030
5031 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5032 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
5033 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
5034 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000 and LPC54100
5035 microcontroller families from NXP.
5036
5037 @quotation Note
5038 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5039 driver:
5040 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5041 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5042 @end quotation
5043
5044 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and one optional parameters,
5045 which must appear in the following order:
5046
5047 @itemize
5048 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5049 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5050 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5051 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
5052 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5053 LPC43x[2357])
5054 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
5055 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5056 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
5057 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
5058 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
5059 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5060 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx and LPC40xx
5061 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5062 at which the core is running
5063 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5064 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5065 @quotation Note
5066 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5067 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5068 However, if you do provide it,
5069 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5070 @end quotation
5071 @end itemize
5072
5073 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5074
5075 @example
5076 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5077 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5078 @end example
5079
5080 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5081 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5082 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5083 @end deffn
5084 @end deffn
5085
5086 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5087 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5088 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5089 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5090 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5091 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5092
5093 @example
5094 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5095 @end example
5096 @end deffn
5097
5098 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5099 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5100 from NXP.
5101
5102 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5103 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5104 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5105 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5106 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5107 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5108 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5109 you start the PLL.
5110
5111 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
5112
5113 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
5114 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
5115 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
5116
5117 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
5118 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
5119 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
5120 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
5121 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
5122 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
5123 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
5124
5125 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
5126 @example
5127 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
5128 @end example
5129
5130 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
5131 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
5132 @code{flash banks} command.
5133
5134 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
5135 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
5136 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
5137 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
5138 a known signature.
5139 Example:
5140 @example
5141 lpc2900 signature 0
5142 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
5143 @end example
5144 @end deffn
5145
5146 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
5147 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
5148 saves it to a file in binary format.
5149 Example:
5150 @example
5151 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
5152 @end example
5153 @end deffn
5154
5155 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
5156 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
5157 commands need to be preceeded by a successful call to the @code{password}
5158 command:
5159
5160 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
5161 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
5162 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
5163 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
5164
5165 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
5166 Example:
5167 @example
5168 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
5169 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
5170 @end example
5171 @end deffn
5172
5173 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
5174 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
5175 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
5176 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
5177 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
5178 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
5179 912 bytes.
5180 @quotation Attention
5181 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5182 @end quotation
5183 Example:
5184 @example
5185 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
5186 @end example
5187 @end deffn
5188
5189 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
5190 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
5191 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
5192 after the next power cycle.
5193 @quotation Attention
5194 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5195 @end quotation
5196 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
5197 Example:
5198 @example
5199 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
5200 flash info 0
5201 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
5202 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5203 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
5204 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5205 @end example
5206 @end deffn
5207
5208 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
5209 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
5210 effective after the next power cycle.
5211 @quotation Attention
5212 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5213 @end quotation
5214 Examples:
5215 @example
5216 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
5217 @end example
5218 @end deffn
5219 @end deffn
5220
5221 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
5222 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
5223 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
5224
5225 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
5226 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
5227 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
5228 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
5229
5230 @example
5231 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5232 @end example
5233 @end deffn
5234
5235 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
5236 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
5237 and integrate flash memory.
5238
5239 @example
5240 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5241 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5242 @end example
5243
5244 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
5245 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5246 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
5247 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
5248 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
5249 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
5250 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
5251 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
5252 @end deffn
5253 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
5254 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
5255 This will remove any Code Protection.
5256 @end deffn
5257 @end deffn
5258
5259 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
5260 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
5261 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M0 cores.
5262 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5263 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5264
5265 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
5266 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
5267
5268 @example
5269 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5270 @end example
5271
5272 psoc4-specific commands
5273 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
5274 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
5275
5276 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
5277 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
5278
5279 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
5280 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
5281 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
5282
5283 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5284 @end deffn
5285
5286 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
5287 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
5288
5289 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5290 @end deffn
5291 @end deffn
5292
5293 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
5294 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
5295 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
5296 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
5297 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5298 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stellaris mass_erase} command.
5299 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5300 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5301
5302 @example
5303 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5304 @end example
5305
5306 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
5307 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
5308 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
5309 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
5310 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
5311 disabled.
5312
5313 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
5314 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
5315 @quotation Warning
5316 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
5317 applied to all of them.
5318 @end quotation
5319 @end deffn
5320 @end deffn
5321
5322 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
5323 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
5324 from ST Microelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
5325 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5326 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5327
5328 @example
5329 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5330 @end example
5331
5332 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5333 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5334 the flash driver.
5335
5336 @example
5337 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5338 @end example
5339
5340 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
5341 as per the following example.
5342 @example
5343 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5344 @end example
5345
5346 Some stm32f1x-specific commands
5347 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stm32f1x mass_erase} command.
5348 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5349 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5350 are defined:
5351
5352 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
5353 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5354 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5355 @end deffn
5356
5357 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
5358 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5359 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5360 @end deffn
5361
5362 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
5363 Read and display the stm32 option bytes written by
5364 the @command{stm32f1x options_write} command.
5365 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5366 @end deffn
5367
5368 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
5369 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
5370 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5371 @end deffn
5372 @end deffn
5373
5374 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
5375 All members of the STM32F2 and STM32F4 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5376 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4 cores.
5377 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5378 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5379
5380 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5381 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5382 the flash driver.
5383
5384 @example
5385 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5386 @end example
5387
5388 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
5389
5390 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
5391 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5392 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5393 @end deffn
5394
5395 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
5396 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5397 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5398 @end deffn
5399 @end deffn
5400
5401 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
5402 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5403 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
5404 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5405 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5406
5407 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5408 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5409 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
5410 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
5411 second bank.
5412
5413 @example
5414 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5415 @end example
5416
5417 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
5418
5419 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
5420 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
5421 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
5422 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
5423 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5424 @end deffn
5425 @end deffn
5426
5427 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
5428 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5429 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5430 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
5431 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
5432
5433 @example
5434 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
5435 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
5436 @end example
5437
5438 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
5439 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
5440 for the specified flash bank.
5441 @end deffn
5442 @end deffn
5443
5444 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
5445 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5446 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
5447 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
5448 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
5449
5450 @example
5451 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5452 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
5453 @end example
5454
5455 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
5456 Configures the str9 flash controller.
5457 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5458
5459 @itemize @bullet
5460 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
5461 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
5462 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5463 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5464 @end itemize
5465 @end deffn
5466
5467 @end deffn
5468
5469 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
5470 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
5471 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5472 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5473
5474 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
5475
5476 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
5477 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
5478 @end deffn
5479
5480 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
5481 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
5482 @end deffn
5483
5484 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
5485 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
5486 the flash clock.
5487 @end deffn
5488 @end deffn
5489
5490 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5491 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5492 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5493
5494 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5495
5496 @itemize
5497 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5498 @end itemize
5499
5500 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5501 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any cmds executed on
5502 the virtual banks are actually performed on the physical banks.
5503 @example
5504 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5505 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5506 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5507 @end example
5508 @end deffn
5509
5510 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5511 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5512 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores.
5513 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5514 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5515 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5516 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5517
5518 @example
5519 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5520 @end example
5521 @end deffn
5522
5523 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
5524 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
5525 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
5526 and SWD interface.
5527 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
5528 If this failes, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
5529
5530 @example
5531 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5532 @end example
5533
5534 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
5535
5536 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
5537 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
5538 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
5539 @end deffn
5540
5541 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
5542 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
5543 @end deffn
5544
5545 @end deffn
5546
5547 @subsection str9xpec driver
5548 @cindex str9xpec
5549
5550 Here is some background info to help
5551 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
5552 the str9:
5553 @enumerate
5554 @item
5555 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
5556 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
5557 @item
5558 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
5559 ISC compilant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
5560 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
5561 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
5562 @end enumerate
5563
5564 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
5565 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
5566 configured for flash bank 0.
5567 @example
5568 # assert srst, we do not want core running
5569 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
5570 jtag_reset 0 1
5571 # turn off target polling
5572 poll off
5573 # disable str9 core
5574 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
5575 # read option bytes
5576 str9xpec options_read 0
5577 # re-enable str9 core
5578 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
5579 poll on
5580 reset halt
5581 @end example
5582 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
5583 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
5584 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
5585 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
5586
5587 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
5588 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
5589 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
5590 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
5591 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
5592
5593 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
5594
5595 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
5596 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
5597 @end deffn
5598
5599 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
5600 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
5601 directly to the embedded flash controller.
5602 @end deffn
5603
5604 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
5605 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
5606 erase the device.
5607 @end deffn
5608
5609 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
5610 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
5611 @end deffn
5612
5613 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
5614 Configure str9 boot bank.
5615 @end deffn
5616
5617 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5618 Configure str9 lvd source.
5619 @end deffn
5620
5621 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
5622 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
5623 @end deffn
5624
5625 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5626 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
5627 @end deffn
5628
5629 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
5630 Read str9 option bytes.
5631 @end deffn
5632
5633 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
5634 Write str9 option bytes.
5635 @end deffn
5636
5637 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
5638 unlock str9 device.
5639 @end deffn
5640
5641 @end deffn
5642
5643 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf51
5644 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
5645 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
5646
5647 @example
5648 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf51 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5649 @end example
5650
5651 Some nrf51-specific commands are defined:
5652
5653 @deffn Command {nrf51 mass_erase}
5654 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
5655 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
5656 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
5657 code.
5658 @end deffn
5659
5660 @end deffn
5661
5662 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5663 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5664 Microcontroller platform.
5665
5666 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5667 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5668
5669 @example
5670 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5671 @end example
5672
5673 @end deffn
5674
5675 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
5676 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
5677 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
5678 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
5679
5680 @example
5681 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
5682 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
5683 @end example
5684
5685 @itemize @bullet
5686 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
5687 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
5688 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
5689 @end itemize
5690
5691 Example usage:
5692 @example
5693 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
5694 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
5695 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
5696 @} else @{
5697 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
5698 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
5699 @}
5700 @end example
5701 @end deffn
5702
5703 @section mFlash
5704
5705 @subsection mFlash Configuration
5706 @cindex mFlash Configuration
5707
5708 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
5709 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
5710 address @var{base}.
5711 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
5712 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
5713
5714 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
5715
5716 @example
5717 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
5718 @end example
5719
5720 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
5721
5722 @example
5723 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
5724 @end example
5725 @end deffn
5726
5727 @subsection mFlash commands
5728 @cindex mFlash commands
5729
5730 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
5731 Configure mflash PLL.
5732 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
5733 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
5734 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
5735 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
5736 @end deffn
5737
5738 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
5739 Configure bootable option.
5740 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
5741 (4kB) for boot.
5742 @end deffn
5743
5744 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
5745 Configure storage information.
5746 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
5747 written.
5748 @end deffn
5749
5750 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
5751 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
5752 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
5753 @end deffn
5754
5755 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
5756 Probe mflash.
5757 @end deffn
5758
5759 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
5760 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
5761 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
5762 @end deffn
5763
5764 @node Flash Programming
5765 @chapter Flash Programming
5766
5767 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
5768 Programming can be acheived by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5769 or using the cmds given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5770
5771 @*To simplify using the flash cmds directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
5772 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
5773
5774 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be peformed.
5775 @enumerate
5776 @item 'init' is executed.
5777 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
5778 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
5779 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
5780 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
5781 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
5782 @end enumerate
5783
5784 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
5785
5786 @example
5787 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
5788 # are optional parameters
5789 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
5790 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
5791
5792 # binary files need the flash address passing
5793 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
5794 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
5795 @end example
5796
5797 @node NAND Flash Commands
5798 @chapter NAND Flash Commands
5799 @cindex NAND
5800
5801 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
5802 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
5803 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
5804
5805 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
5806 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
5807 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
5808 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
5809 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
5810 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
5811
5812 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
5813 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
5814 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
5815 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
5816 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
5817 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
5818 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
5819 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
5820 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
5821 with techniques such as wear leveling.
5822
5823 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
5824 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
5825 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
5826 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
5827 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
5828 every 512 bytes of data.
5829
5830 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
5831 OpenOCD includes the apppropriate kind of ECC. For example,
5832 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
5833 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
5834 ECC mode is used.
5835
5836 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
5837 @enumerate
5838 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
5839 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5840 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
5841 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
5842 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
5843 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
5844 to access that device.
5845 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
5846 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5847 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
5848 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
5849 de-brick a board.
5850 @end enumerate
5851
5852 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
5853 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
5854 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
5855 are only 32 bits wide.
5856 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
5857 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
5858 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
5859 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
5860
5861 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
5862 @section NAND Configuration Commands
5863 @cindex NAND configuration
5864
5865 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
5866 plus some additional configuration that's done after
5867 OpenOCD has initialized.
5868
5869 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
5870 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
5871 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
5872 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
5873 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
5874 they were a single (larger) device.
5875 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
5876 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
5877
5878 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
5879 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
5880 configuration files, not interactively.
5881
5882 @itemize @bullet
5883 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
5884 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
5885 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
5886 associated with the NAND device being declared.
5887 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
5888 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
5889 commands to the NAND controller.
5890 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5891 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
5892 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
5893 for more information.
5894 @end itemize
5895 @end deffn
5896
5897 @deffn Command {nand list}
5898 Prints a summary of each device declared
5899 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
5900 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
5901 @example
5902 > nand list
5903 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
5904 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
5905 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
5906 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
5907 >
5908 @end example
5909 @end deffn
5910
5911 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
5912 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
5913 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
5914 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5915 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
5916 it with most other NAND commands.
5917 @end deffn
5918
5919 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
5920
5921 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
5922 @cindex NAND reading
5923 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
5924 starting at the specified offset.
5925 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5926
5927 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
5928 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
5929
5930 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
5931 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
5932 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
5933
5934 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
5935 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
5936 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
5937 method which handled that error correction.
5938
5939 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
5940 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
5941 @itemize @bullet
5942 @item no oob_* parameter
5943 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
5944 @item @code{oob_raw}
5945 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
5946 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
5947 spare areas associated with each data page.
5948 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
5949 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
5950 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
5951 @item @code{oob_only}
5952 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
5953 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
5954 spare areas associated with each data page.
5955 @end itemize
5956 @end deffn
5957
5958 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
5959 @cindex NAND erasing
5960 @cindex NAND programming
5961 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
5962 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
5963 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
5964 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
5965 If those parameters are not specified,
5966 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
5967 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5968
5969 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
5970 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
5971 block marker.
5972 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
5973 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
5974 @end deffn
5975
5976 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
5977 @cindex NAND writing
5978 @cindex NAND programming
5979 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
5980 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
5981 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
5982 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5983
5984 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
5985 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
5986
5987 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
5988 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
5989 past the end of the device.
5990 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
5991 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
5992 if that's being written.)
5993
5994 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
5995 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
5996 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
5997
5998 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
5999 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
6000 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
6001 @itemize @bullet
6002 @item no oob_* parameter
6003 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6004 If raw acccess is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
6005 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6006 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
6007 with hardware-computed ECC data.
6008 @item @code{oob_only}
6009 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
6010 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
6011 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
6012 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
6013 @item @code{oob_raw}
6014 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
6015 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
6016 un-altered OOB.
6017 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6018 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
6019 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
6020 @item @code{oob_softecc}
6021 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6022 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
6023 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
6024 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6025 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6026 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
6027 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6028 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
6029 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
6030 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6031 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6032 @end itemize
6033 @end deffn
6034
6035 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
6036 @cindex NAND verification
6037 @cindex NAND programming
6038 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
6039 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
6040 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6041
6042 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6043 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6044
6045 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6046 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
6047 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
6048 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
6049 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
6050
6051 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
6052 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
6053 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
6054
6055 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
6056 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
6057 hardward-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
6058 be removed in a future release.
6059 @end deffn
6060
6061 @section Other NAND commands
6062 @cindex NAND other commands
6063
6064 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
6065 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
6066 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
6067 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
6068 continues for @var{length} bytes.
6069 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6070 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6071 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6072
6073 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
6074 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
6075 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
6076 @end deffn
6077
6078 @deffn Command {nand info} num
6079 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6080 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
6081 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
6082 status for each block.
6083 @end deffn
6084
6085 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6086 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
6087 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6088
6089 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
6090 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
6091 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
6092 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
6093 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
6094
6095 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
6096 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
6097 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
6098 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
6099 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
6100 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
6101 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
6102 @end deffn
6103
6104 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
6105 @section NAND Driver List
6106 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
6107 driver-specific options and behaviors.
6108 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
6109
6110 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
6111 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
6112 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
6113 address of the ECC controller.
6114 @example
6115 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
6116 @end example
6117 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
6118 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
6119 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
6120 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
6121 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
6122 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
6123 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
6124 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6125 @end deffn
6126 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
6127 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
6128 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6129 @end deffn
6130
6131 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
6132 properly configured for input or output.
6133 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
6134 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
6135 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6136 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6137 @end deffn
6138 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
6139 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
6140 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6141 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6142 @end deffn
6143 @end deffn
6144
6145 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
6146 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
6147 chips from Texas Instruments.
6148 It takes three extra parameters:
6149 address of the NAND chip;
6150 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
6151 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
6152 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
6153 @example
6154 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
6155 @end example
6156 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
6157 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
6158 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
6159 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
6160 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
6161 @end deffn
6162
6163 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
6164 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6165 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
6166 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
6167 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
6168 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
6169 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6170 @end deffn
6171
6172 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
6173 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
6174 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
6175 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
6176 @end deffn
6177 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
6178
6179 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
6180 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
6181 should work for this chip aswell.
6182 @end deffn
6183
6184 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
6185 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
6186 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
6187 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
6188 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
6189 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
6190 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
6191 @example
6192 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
6193 @end example
6194 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
6195 Turns on/off bad block information swaping from main area,
6196 without parameter query status.
6197 @end deffn
6198 @end deffn
6199
6200 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
6201 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6202 parameter: the address of the controller.
6203 @example
6204 nand device orion 0xd8000000
6205 @end example
6206 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
6207 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6208 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6209 change any behavior.
6210 @end deffn
6211
6212 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
6213 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
6214 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
6215 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
6216 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
6217 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
6218 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
6219 specialized commands.
6220 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6221 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6222 change any behavior.
6223 @end deffn
6224
6225 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
6226 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
6227 @cindex PLD
6228 @cindex FPGA
6229
6230 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
6231 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
6232 OpenOCD can support programming them.
6233 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
6234 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
6235 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
6236 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
6237
6238 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
6239
6240 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
6241 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
6242 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
6243
6244 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
6245 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
6246
6247 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
6248 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
6249 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
6250 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
6251 behavior.
6252 @end deffn
6253
6254 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
6255 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
6256 @end deffn
6257
6258 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
6259 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
6260 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
6261 @end deffn
6262
6263 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
6264
6265 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
6266 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
6267 that particular type of PLD.
6268
6269 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2
6270 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
6271 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
6272 No driver-specific PLD definition options are used,
6273 and one driver-specific command is defined.
6274
6275 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
6276 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
6277 for FPGA @var{num}.
6278 @end deffn
6279 @end deffn
6280
6281 @node General Commands
6282 @chapter General Commands
6283 @cindex commands
6284
6285 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
6286 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
6287 commands are documented elsewhere.
6288
6289 Intent:
6290 @itemize @bullet
6291 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
6292 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
6293 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programatically,
6294 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
6295
6296 @item @b{From the human}
6297 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
6298 or via GDB (default port 3333).
6299
6300 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
6301 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
6302 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
6303
6304 @item @b{Machine Interface}
6305 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
6306 port is 5555.
6307 @end itemize
6308
6309
6310 @section Daemon Commands
6311
6312 @deffn {Command} exit
6313 Exits the current telnet session.
6314 @end deffn
6315
6316 @deffn {Command} help [string]
6317 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
6318 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
6319 Not every command provides helptext.
6320
6321 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
6322 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
6323 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
6324 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
6325 @end deffn
6326
6327 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
6328 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
6329 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
6330 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
6331 Useful in connection with script files
6332 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
6333 @end deffn
6334
6335 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
6336 Close the OpenOCD daemon, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
6337 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
6338 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
6339 @end deffn
6340
6341 @anchor{debuglevel}
6342 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
6343 @cindex message level
6344 Display debug level.
6345 If @var{n} (from 0..3) is provided, then set it to that level.
6346 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
6347 Level 0 is error messages only;
6348 level 1 adds warnings;
6349 level 2 adds informational messages;
6350 and level 3 adds debugging messages.
6351 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
6352 the command line along with the location of that log
6353 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
6354 @xref{Running}.
6355 @end deffn
6356
6357 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
6358 Logs a message at "user" priority.
6359 Output @var{message} to stdout.
6360 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
6361 @example
6362 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
6363 @end example
6364 @end deffn
6365
6366 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
6367 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
6368 the initial log output channel is stderr.
6369 @end deffn
6370
6371 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
6372 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
6373 @end deffn
6374
6375 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
6376 @section Target State handling
6377 @cindex reset
6378 @cindex halt
6379 @cindex target initialization
6380
6381 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
6382 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
6383 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
6384 a current target which is used to perform the
6385 various operations. The current target may be changed
6386 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
6387 target which should become current.
6388
6389 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
6390 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
6391 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
6392 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
6393 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
6394
6395 @emph{With no arguments}:
6396 list all available registers for the current target,
6397 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
6398 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
6399 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
6400 are flagged as such.
6401
6402 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
6403 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
6404 bypassing any internal cache.
6405
6406 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
6407 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
6408 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
6409 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
6410 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
6411 relevant module will flush such values.
6412
6413 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
6414 Debug and trace infrastructure:
6415
6416 @example
6417 > reg
6418 ===== ARM registers
6419 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
6420 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
6421 (2) r2 (/32)
6422 ...
6423 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
6424 >
6425 @end example
6426 @end deffn
6427
6428 @deffn Command halt [ms]
6429 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
6430 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
6431 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
6432 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
6433 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
6434 (and enter debug mode).
6435 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
6436
6437 @quotation Warning
6438 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
6439 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
6440 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
6441 power mode by gating the core clock;
6442 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
6443
6444 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
6445 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
6446 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
6447 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
6448 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
6449 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
6450
6451 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
6452 work with a JTAG debugger.
6453 Tasking environments generaly have idle loops where the body is the
6454 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
6455 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
6456 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
6457 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
6458 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
6459 @end quotation
6460
6461 @end deffn
6462
6463 @deffn Command resume [address]
6464 Resume the target at its current code position,
6465 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6466 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
6467 @end deffn
6468
6469 @deffn Command step [address]
6470 Single-step the target at its current code position,
6471 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6472 @end deffn
6473
6474 @anchor{resetcommand}
6475 @deffn Command reset
6476 @deffnx Command {reset run}
6477 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
6478 @deffnx Command {reset init}
6479 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
6480 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
6481 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
6482
6483 The optional parameter specifies what should
6484 happen after the reset.
6485 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
6486 The other options will not work on all systems.
6487 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
6488
6489 @itemize @minus
6490 @item @b{run} Let the target run
6491 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
6492 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
6493 @end itemize
6494 @end deffn
6495
6496 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
6497 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
6498 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
6499 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
6500 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
6501 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
6502 state.
6503 @end deffn
6504
6505 @section I/O Utilities
6506
6507 These commands are available when
6508 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
6509 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
6510 notably the ZY1000.
6511 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
6512
6513 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
6514
6515 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
6516 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
6517 the text file @file{filename}.
6518 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
6519 The last string is followed by a newline.
6520 @end deffn
6521
6522 @deffn Command cat filename
6523 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
6524 @end deffn
6525
6526 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
6527 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
6528 into @file{dest_filename}.
6529 @end deffn
6530
6531 @deffn Command ip
6532 @emph{No description provided.}
6533 @end deffn
6534
6535 @deffn Command ls
6536 @emph{No description provided.}
6537 @end deffn
6538
6539 @deffn Command mac
6540 @emph{No description provided.}
6541 @end deffn
6542
6543 @deffn Command meminfo
6544 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
6545 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
6546 @end deffn
6547
6548 @deffn Command peek
6549 @emph{No description provided.}
6550 @end deffn
6551
6552 @deffn Command poke
6553 @emph{No description provided.}
6554 @end deffn
6555
6556 @deffn Command rm filename
6557 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
6558 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
6559 @end deffn
6560
6561 @deffn Command trunc filename
6562 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
6563 @end deffn
6564
6565 @anchor{memoryaccess}
6566 @section Memory access commands
6567 @cindex memory access
6568
6569 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
6570 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
6571 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
6572 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
6573
6574 @enumerate
6575 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
6576 to change the current target.
6577 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
6578 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
6579 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
6580 @end enumerate
6581
6582 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
6583 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
6584 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
6585 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
6586 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
6587 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
6588 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6589 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6590 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6591 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6592 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
6593 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
6594 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
6595 @end deffn
6596
6597 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
6598 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
6599 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
6600 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
6601 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
6602 at the specified address @var{addr}.
6603 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6604 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6605 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6606 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6607 @end deffn
6608
6609 @anchor{imageaccess}
6610 @section Image loading commands
6611 @cindex image loading
6612 @cindex image dumping
6613
6614 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
6615 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
6616 binary file named @var{filename}.
6617 @end deffn
6618
6619 @deffn Command {fast_load}
6620 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
6621 current target. Must be preceeded by fast_load_image.
6622 @end deffn
6623
6624 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
6625 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
6626 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
6627 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
6628 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
6629 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
6630 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
6631 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
6632 separately.
6633 @end deffn
6634
6635 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
6636 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
6637 The file format may optionally be specified
6638 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
6639 In addition the following arguments may be specifed:
6640 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
6641 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
6642 @example
6643 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
6644 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
6645 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
6646 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
6647 $address $length
6648 @}
6649 @end example
6650 @end deffn
6651
6652 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
6653 Displays image section sizes and addresses
6654 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
6655 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
6656 The file format may optionally be specified
6657 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
6658 @end deffn
6659
6660 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
6661 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
6662 The file format may optionally be specified
6663 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
6664 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
6665 @end deffn
6666
6667
6668 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
6669 @cindex breakpoint
6670 @cindex watchpoint
6671
6672 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
6673 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
6674 watchpoints.
6675 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
6676
6677 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
6678 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
6679 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
6680 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
6681 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
6682 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
6683
6684 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
6685 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
6686 @end deffn
6687
6688 @deffn Command {rbp} address
6689 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
6690 @end deffn
6691
6692 @deffn Command {rwp} address
6693 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
6694 @end deffn
6695
6696 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
6697 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
6698 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
6699 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
6700 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
6701 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
6702 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
6703 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
6704 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
6705 @end deffn
6706
6707 @section Misc Commands
6708
6709 @cindex profiling
6710 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
6711 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
6712 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
6713 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
6714 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
6715 limit the address range.
6716 @end deffn
6717
6718 @deffn Command {version}
6719 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
6720 @end deffn
6721
6722 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
6723 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
6724 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
6725 @end deffn
6726
6727 @node Architecture and Core Commands
6728 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
6729 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
6730 @cindex Core Specific Commands
6731
6732 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
6733 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
6734 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
6735 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
6736
6737 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
6738 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
6739 @cindex tracing
6740 @cindex ETM
6741 @cindex ETB
6742
6743 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
6744 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
6745 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
6746
6747 @itemize
6748 @item
6749 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
6750 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
6751 supports such an interface.
6752 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
6753 and trace port support.)
6754 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
6755 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
6756 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
6757 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
6758 in the board-specific configuration file.
6759 @item
6760 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
6761 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
6762 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
6763 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
6764 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
6765 @end itemize
6766
6767 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
6768
6769 @quotation Issues
6770 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
6771 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
6772
6773 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
6774 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
6775 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
6776 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
6777 dummy trace port driver}.
6778
6779 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
6780 as well as tracing only during specific states
6781 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
6782
6783 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
6784 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
6785 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
6786 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
6787 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
6788
6789 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
6790 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
6791 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
6792 this original style of JTAG access.
6793 @end quotation
6794
6795 @subsection ETM Configuration
6796 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
6797
6798 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
6799 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
6800 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
6801
6802 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
6803 which are a function of silicon capabilties (exposed later
6804 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
6805 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
6806 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
6807 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
6808 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
6809 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
6810 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
6811
6812 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
6813 or @option{demultiplexed}.
6814 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
6815
6816 @quotation Warning
6817 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
6818 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
6819 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
6820 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
6821 @end quotation
6822
6823 @quotation Note
6824 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
6825 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
6826 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
6827 what CPU activities are traced.
6828 @end quotation
6829 @end deffn
6830
6831 @deffn Command {etm info}
6832 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
6833 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
6834 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
6835 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
6836 @end deffn
6837
6838 @deffn Command {etm status}
6839 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
6840 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
6841 Did trace data overflow?
6842 Was it triggered?
6843 @end deffn
6844
6845 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
6846 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
6847 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
6848 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
6849 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
6850
6851 @itemize
6852 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
6853 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
6854 The value is one of
6855 @option{none} (save nothing),
6856 @option{data} (save data),
6857 @option{address} (save addresses),
6858 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
6859 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
6860 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
6861 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
6862 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
6863 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
6864 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
6865 trace stream without an image of the code.
6866 @end itemize
6867 @end deffn
6868
6869 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6870 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
6871 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
6872 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
6873 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
6874
6875 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
6876 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
6877 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
6878 @end deffn
6879
6880 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
6881
6882 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
6883 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
6884 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
6885
6886 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
6887 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
6888 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
6889 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
6890 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
6891 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
6892 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
6893
6894 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
6895
6896 @itemize
6897 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
6898 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
6899 for instruction access within that function's body.
6900 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
6901 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
6902 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
6903 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
6904 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
6905 combining one of the above models with a counter.
6906 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
6907 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
6908 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
6909 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
6910 @item @emph{... more}
6911 @end itemize
6912
6913 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
6914 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
6915
6916 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
6917 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
6918 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
6919 @end deffn
6920
6921 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
6922 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
6923 @end deffn
6924
6925 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
6926 Opens an image file.
6927 @end deffn
6928
6929 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
6930 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
6931 @end deffn
6932
6933 @deffn Command {etm start}
6934 Starts trace data collection.
6935 @end deffn
6936
6937 @deffn Command {etm stop}
6938 Stops trace data collection.
6939 @end deffn
6940
6941 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
6942 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
6943
6944 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
6945
6946 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
6947 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
6948 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
6949 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
6950 any trace data collection.}
6951 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
6952 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
6953 @end deffn
6954 @end deffn
6955
6956 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
6957 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
6958 to use on-chip ETB memory.
6959 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
6960 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
6961 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
6962 @end deffn
6963 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
6964 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
6965 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
6966 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
6967 trace trigger becomes active.
6968
6969 @itemize
6970 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
6971 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
6972 afterwards.
6973 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
6974 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
6975 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
6976 what caused that event to happen.
6977 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
6978 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
6979 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
6980 how the event caused trouble.
6981 @end itemize
6982 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
6983 @end deffn
6984
6985 @end deffn
6986
6987 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
6988 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
6989 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
6990 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
6991 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
6992
6993 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
6994 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
6995
6996 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
6997 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
6998 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
6999 @end deffn
7000
7001 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
7002 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
7003 @end deffn
7004
7005 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
7006 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
7007 @end deffn
7008 @end deffn
7009
7010
7011 @section Generic ARM
7012 @cindex ARM
7013
7014 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
7015 They are available in addition to other core-specific
7016 commands that may be available.
7017
7018 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
7019 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
7020 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
7021 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
7022 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7023 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
7024 @end deffn
7025
7026 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
7027 @cindex disassemble
7028 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
7029 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
7030 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
7031 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
7032 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
7033 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7034 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
7035
7036 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
7037 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
7038 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
7039 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
7040 with a handful of exceptions.
7041 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
7042 @end deffn
7043
7044 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
7045 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
7046 passing parameters @var{CRn},
7047 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7048 and using the MCR instruction.
7049 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7050 an ARM register.)
7051 @end deffn
7052
7053 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
7054 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
7055 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7056 and the MRC instruction.
7057 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
7058 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7059 an ARM register.)
7060 @end deffn
7061
7062 @deffn Command {arm reg}
7063 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
7064 core mode if necessary.
7065 @end deffn
7066
7067 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7068 @cindex ARM semihosting
7069 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
7070
7071 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
7072 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
7073 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
7074 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
7075 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
7076 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
7077 @end deffn
7078
7079 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
7080 @cindex ARMv4
7081 @cindex ARMv5
7082
7083 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
7084 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
7085 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
7086 variant.
7087
7088 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
7089 @cindex ARM7
7090 @cindex ARM9
7091
7092 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
7093 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
7094 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
7095 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
7096
7097 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7098 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
7099 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
7100 instead of breakpoints.
7101 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7102
7103 This should be
7104 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
7105 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
7106 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
7107 @end deffn
7108
7109 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7110 @cindex DCC
7111 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
7112 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
7113 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7114
7115 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
7116 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
7117 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
7118 @end deffn
7119
7120 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7121 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
7122 that don't check completion of the operation.
7123 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7124
7125 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
7126 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
7127 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
7128 @end deffn
7129
7130 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
7131 @cindex ARM720T
7132
7133 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
7134 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7135 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
7136 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
7137
7138 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
7139 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7140 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7141
7142 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
7143 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7144 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
7145 @end deffn
7146
7147 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
7148 @cindex ARM9
7149
7150 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
7151 integer processors.
7152 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
7153
7154 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
7155 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
7156 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
7157 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
7158
7159 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
7160 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7161 @cindex vector_catch
7162 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
7163 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
7164 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
7165 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
7166 to those hardware vectors.
7167
7168 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
7169 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
7170 vector catch hardware to intercept
7171 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
7172 @option{none} of them,
7173 or a list with one or more of the following:
7174 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
7175 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
7176 @end deffn
7177
7178 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
7179 @cindex ARM920T
7180
7181 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
7182 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7183 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
7184 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7185 and ARM9 commands.
7186
7187 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
7188 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
7189 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
7190 @end deffn
7191
7192 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
7193 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7194 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7195 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
7196 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
7197 (Not all registers can be written.)
7198 @end deffn
7199
7200 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
7201 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7202 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7203
7204 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
7205 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
7206 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
7207 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
7208 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
7209 or using zero if no other address is provided.
7210 @end deffn
7211
7212 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
7213 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
7214 @end deffn
7215
7216 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
7217 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
7218 @end deffn
7219
7220 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
7221 @cindex ARM926ej-s
7222
7223 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
7224 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
7225 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
7226 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7227 and ARM9 commands.
7228
7229 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
7230 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
7231
7232 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
7233 Print information about the caches found.
7234 @end deffn
7235
7236 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
7237 @cindex ARM966E
7238
7239 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
7240 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7241 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7242 and ARM9 commands.
7243
7244 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
7245 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7246 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7247 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
7248 ARM966E-S TRM.
7249 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
7250 as required for BIST support.
7251 @end deffn
7252
7253 @subsection XScale specific commands
7254 @cindex XScale
7255
7256 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
7257
7258 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
7259 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
7260 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
7261 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
7262 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
7263 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
7264 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
7265
7266 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
7267 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicity write
7268 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
7269 the mini-IC.
7270
7271 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
7272 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
7273 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
7274 code layout in memory:
7275 @example
7276 _vectors:
7277 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7278 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7279 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7280 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7281 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7282 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7283 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7284 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7285 .org 0x100
7286 .long real_reset_vector
7287 .long real_ui_handler
7288 .long real_swi_handler
7289 .long real_pf_abort
7290 .long real_data_abort
7291 .long 0 /* unused */
7292 .long real_irq_handler
7293 .long real_fiq_handler
7294 @end example
7295
7296 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
7297 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
7298 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
7299 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
7300 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
7301 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
7302 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
7303 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
7304 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
7305 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
7306 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
7307 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
7308 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
7309 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
7310 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
7311 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
7312 software.
7313
7314 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
7315 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
7316 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
7317 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
7318
7319 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
7320 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
7321 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
7322 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
7323 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
7324 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
7325 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
7326 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
7327 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
7328
7329 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
7330 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7331
7332 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
7333 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
7334 @end deffn
7335
7336 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
7337 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
7338 @end deffn
7339
7340 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
7341 Displays information about the CPU caches.
7342 @end deffn
7343
7344 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
7345 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7346 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7347 @end deffn
7348
7349 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
7350 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
7351 @end deffn
7352
7353 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7354 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
7355 @end deffn
7356
7357 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
7358 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
7359 @end deffn
7360
7361 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7362 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
7363 @end deffn
7364
7365 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7366 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
7367 @end deffn
7368
7369 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
7370 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
7371 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
7372 and modifying how it is emptied.
7373 @end deffn
7374
7375 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
7376 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
7377 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
7378 The image @var{type} may be one of
7379 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
7380 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
7381 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
7382 @end deffn
7383
7384 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
7385 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
7386 @cindex vector_catch
7387 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
7388 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
7389
7390 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
7391 @example
7392 0x01 Trap Reset
7393 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
7394 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
7395 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
7396 0x10 Trap Data Abort
7397 0x20 reserved
7398 0x40 Trap IRQ
7399 0x80 Trap FIQ
7400 @end example
7401 @end deffn
7402
7403 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
7404 @cindex vector_table
7405
7406 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
7407 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
7408 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
7409 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
7410 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
7411
7412 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
7413
7414 @end deffn
7415
7416 @section ARMv6 Architecture
7417 @cindex ARMv6
7418
7419 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
7420 @cindex ARM11
7421
7422 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7423 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
7424 which is enabled by default.
7425 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7426 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
7427 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
7428 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
7429 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
7430 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
7431 @end deffn
7432
7433 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7434 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
7435 which is enabled by default.
7436 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7437 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
7438 @end deffn
7439
7440 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7441 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
7442 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
7443 they are disabled by default.
7444 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
7445 @end deffn
7446
7447 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
7448 @cindex vector_catch
7449 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
7450 coprocessor 14 register 7.
7451 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7452
7453 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7454 for certain hardware events.
7455 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
7456 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
7457 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
7458 @end deffn
7459
7460 @section ARMv7 Architecture
7461 @cindex ARMv7
7462
7463 @subsection ARMv7 Debug Access Port (DAP) specific commands
7464 @cindex Debug Access Port
7465 @cindex DAP
7466 These commands are specific to ARM architecture v7 Debug Access Port (DAP),
7467 included on Cortex-M and Cortex-A systems.
7468 They are available in addition to other core-specific commands that may be available.
7469
7470 @deffn Command {dap apid} [num]
7471 Displays ID register from AP @var{num},
7472 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7473 @end deffn
7474
7475 @deffn Command {dap apsel} [num]
7476 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
7477 @end deffn
7478
7479 @deffn Command {dap baseaddr} [num]
7480 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
7481 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7482 @end deffn
7483
7484 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
7485 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
7486 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7487 @end deffn
7488
7489 @deffn Command {dap memaccess} [value]
7490 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
7491 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
7492 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7493 @end deffn
7494
7495 @deffn Command {dap apcsw} [0 / 1]
7496 fix CSW_SPROT from register AP_REG_CSW on selected dap.
7497 Defaulting to 0.
7498 @end deffn
7499
7500 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
7501 @cindex tracing
7502 @cindex SWO
7503 @cindex SWV
7504 @cindex TPIU
7505 @cindex ITM
7506 @cindex ETM
7507
7508 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal @var{filename}}) @
7509 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
7510 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
7511
7512 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
7513 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
7514 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
7515 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
7516
7517 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
7518 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
7519 debugger adapter features.
7520
7521 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
7522 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
7523
7524 Command options:
7525 @itemize @minus
7526 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
7527 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
7528 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
7529 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
7530 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
7531 either a regular file or a named pipe);
7532 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
7533 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
7534 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
7535 coding;
7536 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
7537 regular UART 8N1) coding;
7538 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
7539 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
7540 data is to be output via SWO;
7541 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
7542 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
7543 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
7544 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
7545 rate automatically.
7546 @end itemize
7547
7548 Example usage:
7549 @enumerate
7550 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
7551 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
7552 enough to:
7553 @example
7554 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
7555 ...
7556 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
7557 ...
7558 @end example
7559 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
7560 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
7561 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
7562 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
7563 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
7564 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
7565 @example
7566 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
7567 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
7568 @end example
7569 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
7570 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
7571 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
7572 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
7573 @example
7574 openocd -f interface/stlink-v2-1.cfg \
7575 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
7576 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
7577 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
7578 @end example
7579 @end enumerate
7580 @end deffn
7581
7582 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7583 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
7584 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
7585 @end deffn
7586
7587 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7588 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
7589 @end deffn
7590
7591 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
7592 @cindex Cortex-M
7593
7594 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7595 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
7596
7597 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping a way they get
7598 served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
7599 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
7600 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
7601 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
7602 the step command leaves with the core running.
7603
7604 Note that a free breakpoint is required for the @option{auto} option. If no
7605 breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step is taken
7606 with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option does.
7607
7608 Default is @option{auto}.
7609 @end deffn
7610
7611 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7612 @cindex vector_catch
7613 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7614 for certain hardware events.
7615
7616 Parameters request interception of
7617 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
7618 @option{none} of them,
7619 or one or more of the following:
7620 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
7621 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
7622 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
7623 @option{irq_err},
7624 @option{state_err},
7625 @option{chk_err}, or
7626 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
7627 @option{reset}.
7628 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
7629 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
7630 are mapped to HardFault.
7631 UsageFault checks for
7632 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
7633 must also be explicitly enabled.
7634
7635 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
7636 @end deffn
7637
7638 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{srst}|@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
7639 Control reset handling. The default @option{srst} is to use srst if fitted,
7640 otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
7641 @itemize @minus
7642 @item @option{srst} use hardware srst if fitted otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
7643 @item @option{sysresetreq} use NVIC SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
7644 @item @option{vectreset} use NVIC VECTRESET to reset system.
7645 @end itemize
7646 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for all current Cortex-M cores.
7647 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
7648 are uneffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler to manually reset
7649 the peripherals.
7650 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
7651 @end deffn
7652
7653 @section Intel Architecture
7654
7655 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
7656 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
7657 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
7658 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
7659 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
7660 @itemize
7661 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
7662 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
7663 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
7664 @end itemize
7665
7666 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
7667 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
7668 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
7669
7670 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
7671 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7672 @end deffn
7673
7674 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
7675 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7676 @end deffn
7677
7678 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
7679 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7680 @end deffn
7681
7682 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
7683 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7684 @end deffn
7685
7686 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
7687 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7688 @end deffn
7689
7690 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
7691 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7692 @end deffn
7693
7694 @section OpenRISC Architecture
7695
7696 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
7697 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
7698
7699 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
7700 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
7701 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
7702 @end deffn
7703 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
7704 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
7705
7706 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
7707
7708 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
7709 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
7710 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
7711 @end deffn
7712
7713 @subsection Registers commands
7714 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
7715 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
7716 included in the generated target descriptor file.
7717
7718 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
7719
7720 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
7721 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
7722 and "timer" groups.
7723
7724 @emph{example:}
7725 @example
7726 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
7727 @end example
7728
7729
7730 @end deffn
7731 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
7732 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
7733
7734 @emph{group} can be "system",
7735 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
7736 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
7737 @end deffn
7738
7739 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
7740 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
7741 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
7742 @cindex tracing
7743 @cindex libdcc
7744 @cindex DCC
7745 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
7746 the target uses appropriate libraries.
7747 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
7748 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
7749
7750 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
7751 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
7752 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
7753 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
7754 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
7755 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
7756
7757 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
7758 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
7759 arrays of various size integers from the target,
7760 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
7761 The target being debugged may
7762 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
7763 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
7764 each supported by a command:
7765
7766 @itemize
7767 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
7768 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
7769 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
7770 finding out how some fault was triggered.
7771
7772 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
7773 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
7774 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
7775
7776 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
7777 and then displayed at any time.
7778 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
7779
7780 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
7781 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
7782 @end itemize
7783
7784 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
7785 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
7786 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
7787 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
7788 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
7789 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
7790 does the same thing.
7791
7792 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
7793 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
7794 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
7795 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
7796 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
7797
7798 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
7799 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
7800 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
7801 @end deffn
7802
7803 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
7804 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
7805 in the order they triggered.
7806 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
7807 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
7808 history records.
7809 @end deffn
7810
7811 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
7812 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
7813 they have been triggered.
7814 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
7815 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
7816 and associates it with that identifier.
7817
7818 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
7819 are not related except by this command.
7820 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
7821 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
7822 @end deffn
7823
7824
7825 @node JTAG Commands
7826 @chapter JTAG Commands
7827 @cindex JTAG Commands
7828 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
7829 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
7830 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
7831 may be needed to work with targets which require special
7832 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
7833
7834 To use these commands you will need to understand some
7835 of the basics of JTAG, including:
7836
7837 @itemize @bullet
7838 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
7839 devices such as a CPUs.
7840 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
7841 standard state machine (in parallel)
7842 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
7843 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
7844 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
7845 while the reading previous ones.
7846 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
7847 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
7848 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
7849 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
7850 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
7851 registers.
7852 @end itemize
7853
7854 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
7855
7856 These commands are used by developers who need to access
7857 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
7858 the order of TAP state transitions.
7859 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
7860 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
7861 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
7862 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
7863 these commands are not available.
7864
7865 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
7866 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
7867 that specify the entire register.
7868 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
7869 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
7870 The return value holds the original value of each
7871 of those fields.
7872
7873 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
7874 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
7875 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
7876 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
7877 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
7878
7879 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
7880 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
7881
7882 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
7883 in that state.
7884 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
7885 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
7886 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
7887
7888 @quotation Warning
7889 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
7890 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
7891 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
7892 data registers, which may have different lengths.
7893 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
7894 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
7895 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
7896 (by connecting a different scan chain).
7897 @end quotation
7898 @end deffn
7899
7900 @deffn Command {flush_count}
7901 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
7902 This may be used for performance tuning.
7903
7904 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
7905 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
7906 not change with the amount of data which is written.
7907 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
7908 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
7909 instead of batching them into larger operations.
7910 @end deffn
7911
7912 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
7913 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
7914 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
7915 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
7916 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
7917 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
7918
7919 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
7920 in that state.
7921 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
7922 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
7923 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
7924
7925 @quotation Note
7926 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
7927 register values, unlike data register values.
7928 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
7929 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
7930 @end quotation
7931 @end deffn
7932
7933 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
7934 Set values of reset signals.
7935 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
7936 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
7937 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
7938 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
7939 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
7940 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
7941 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7942
7943 Note that TRST is specially handled.
7944 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
7945 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
7946 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
7947 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
7948 instead of the TRST signal.
7949 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
7950 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
7951 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
7952 with handlers for that event.
7953 @end deffn
7954
7955 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
7956 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
7957 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
7958 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
7959 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
7960 Then, in a series of single state transitions
7961 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
7962 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
7963 The final state must also be stable.
7964 @end deffn
7965
7966 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
7967 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
7968 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
7969 Instructions often need some time
7970 to execute before they take effect.
7971 @end deffn
7972
7973 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
7974 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
7975
7976 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7977 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
7978 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
7979 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
7980 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
7981 @end deffn
7982
7983 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7984 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
7985 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
7986 must also be enabled.
7987 Default is enabled.
7988 @end deffn
7989
7990 @section TAP state names
7991 @cindex TAP state names
7992
7993 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
7994 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
7995 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
7996 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
7997
7998 @itemize @bullet
7999 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
8000 acts as if TRST were pulsed
8001 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
8002 @item @b{DRSELECT}
8003 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
8004 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8005 through the data register
8006 @item @b{DREXIT1}
8007 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
8008 for update or more shifting
8009 @item @b{DREXIT2}
8010 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
8011 @item @b{IRSELECT}
8012 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
8013 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8014 through the instruction register
8015 @item @b{IREXIT1}
8016 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
8017 for update or more shifting
8018 @item @b{IREXIT2}
8019 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
8020 @end itemize
8021
8022 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
8023 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
8024 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
8025 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
8026
8027 @itemize @bullet
8028 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
8029 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
8030 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
8031 may not be as expected.
8032 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
8033 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
8034 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
8035 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
8036 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
8037 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
8038 @end itemize
8039
8040 @node Boundary Scan Commands
8041 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
8042
8043 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
8044 boundary scan based hardware testing.
8045 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
8046 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
8047
8048 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
8049 @cindex Serial Vector Format
8050 @cindex SVF
8051
8052 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
8053 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
8054 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8055 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8056
8057 @deffn Command {svf} filename [@option{quiet}]
8058 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8059 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
8060 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8061 each command is logged before it is executed.
8062 @end deffn
8063
8064 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8065 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8066 @cindex XSVF
8067
8068 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
8069 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
8070 Xilinx devices.
8071 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8072 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8073
8074 @quotation Important
8075 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
8076 @end quotation
8077
8078 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
8079 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8080 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
8081 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
8082 that TAP.
8083 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
8084 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
8085 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8086 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
8087 @end deffn
8088
8089 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
8090 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
8091 after building the software.
8092 You may find them useful:
8093
8094 @itemize
8095 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
8096 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
8097 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
8098 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
8099 @end itemize
8100
8101 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
8102 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
8103 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
8104 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
8105 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
8106 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
8107 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
8108
8109
8110 @node Utility Commands
8111 @chapter Utility Commands
8112 @cindex Utility Commands
8113
8114 @section RAM testing
8115 @cindex RAM testing
8116
8117 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
8118 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
8119 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
8120 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
8121 hardware problems.
8122
8123 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
8124 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
8125 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
8126 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
8127
8128 Load the memory testing functions with
8129
8130 @example
8131 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
8132 @end example
8133
8134 to get access to the following facilities:
8135
8136 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
8137 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
8138 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
8139 @end deffn
8140
8141 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
8142 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
8143 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
8144 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
8145 @end deffn
8146
8147 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
8148 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
8149 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
8150 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
8151 @end deffn
8152
8153 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
8154 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
8155 @end deffn
8156
8157 @section Firmware recovery helpers
8158 @cindex Firmware recovery
8159
8160 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
8161 devices recovery with JTAG.
8162
8163 For quickstart instructions run:
8164 @example
8165 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
8166 @end example
8167
8168 @node TFTP
8169 @chapter TFTP
8170 @cindex TFTP
8171 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
8172 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
8173
8174 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
8175 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
8176 server (tftpd). For example,
8177
8178 @example
8179 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
8180 @end example
8181
8182 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
8183 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
8184
8185 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
8186 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
8187 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
8188 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
8189
8190 @node GDB and OpenOCD
8191 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
8192 @cindex GDB
8193 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
8194 to debug remote targets.
8195 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
8196
8197 @itemize
8198 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
8199 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
8200 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
8201 as shown in this chapter.
8202 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
8203 that also will probably need to be configured.
8204 @end itemize
8205
8206 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
8207 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
8208 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
8209 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
8210 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
8211 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
8212
8213 @section Connecting to GDB
8214 @cindex Connecting to GDB
8215 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
8216 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
8217 errors, which has since been fixed; see
8218 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
8219
8220 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
8221
8222 @enumerate
8223 @item
8224 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
8225 @example
8226 target remote localhost:3333
8227 @end example
8228 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
8229
8230 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
8231 @example
8232 target extended-remote localhost:3333
8233 @end example
8234 @item
8235 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
8236 @example
8237 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
8238 @end example
8239 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
8240 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
8241 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
8242 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
8243 @end enumerate
8244
8245 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
8246 GDB command line.
8247
8248 @section Sample GDB session startup
8249
8250 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
8251 than they do when you're debugging locally.
8252 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
8253 small ARM program.
8254 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
8255 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
8256
8257 @example
8258 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
8259 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
8260 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
8261 ...
8262 (gdb) monitor reset halt
8263 ...
8264 (gdb) load
8265 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
8266 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
8267 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
8268 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
8269 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
8270 (gdb) continue
8271 Continuing.
8272 ...
8273 @end example
8274
8275 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
8276 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
8277 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
8278 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
8279
8280 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
8281
8282 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
8283 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
8284 packet size and the device's memory map.
8285 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
8286 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
8287 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
8288
8289 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
8290 You may need to set those up by hand.
8291 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
8292 something like:
8293
8294 @example
8295 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
8296 @end example
8297
8298 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
8299
8300 @example
8301 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
8302 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
8303 @end example
8304
8305 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
8306 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
8307 do not have such restrictions.
8308
8309 Another example of useful GDB configuration came from a user who
8310 found that single stepping his Cortex-M3 didn't work well with IRQs
8311 and an RTOS until he told GDB to disable the IRQs while stepping:
8312
8313 @example
8314 define hook-step
8315 mon cortex_m maskisr on
8316 end
8317 define hookpost-step
8318 mon cortex_m maskisr off
8319 end
8320 @end example
8321
8322 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
8323 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
8324 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
8325 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
8326
8327 @section Programming using GDB
8328 @cindex Programming using GDB
8329 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
8330
8331 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
8332 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
8333 @example
8334 gdb_memory_map disable
8335 @end example
8336 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
8337 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
8338 working area.
8339
8340 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
8341 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
8342 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
8343 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
8344
8345 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
8346 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
8347
8348 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
8349 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
8350 @example
8351 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
8352 @end example
8353
8354 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
8355 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
8356
8357 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
8358 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
8359 will be used.
8360
8361 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, an event
8362 script can be executed:
8363 @example
8364 $_TARGETNAME configure -event EVENTNAME BODY
8365 @end example
8366
8367 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
8368 can be used.
8369 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
8370 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
8371 @cindex SMP
8372 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
8373 @itemize @bullet
8374 @item j - smp status request
8375 @item J - smp set request
8376 @end itemize
8377
8378 OpenOCD implements :
8379 @itemize @bullet
8380 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
8381 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
8382 @option{E01} for target not smp.
8383 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
8384 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
8385 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
8386 @end itemize
8387
8388 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
8389 @itemize @bullet
8390 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
8391 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
8392 @example
8393 set $_core 1
8394 #Jc01 packet is sent
8395 print $_core
8396 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
8397 @end example
8398
8399 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
8400 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
8401
8402 @example
8403 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
8404 define toggle0
8405 maint packet Jc0
8406 continue
8407 main packet Jc-1
8408 end
8409 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
8410 define toggle1
8411 maint packet Jc1
8412 continue
8413 main packet Jc-1
8414 end
8415 @end example
8416 @end itemize
8417
8418 @section RTOS Support
8419 @cindex RTOS Support
8420 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
8421
8422 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
8423 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
8424
8425 @* An example setup is below:
8426
8427 @example
8428 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
8429 @end example
8430
8431 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
8432
8433 Currently supported rtos's include:
8434 @itemize @bullet
8435 @item @option{eCos}
8436 @item @option{ThreadX}
8437 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
8438 @item @option{linux}
8439 @item @option{ChibiOS}
8440 @item @option{embKernel}
8441 @item @option{mqx}
8442 @end itemize
8443
8444 @quotation Note
8445 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
8446 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
8447 @end quotation
8448
8449 @table @code
8450 @item eCos symbols
8451 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
8452 @item ThreadX symbols
8453 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
8454 @item FreeRTOS symbols
8455 @raggedright
8456 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
8457 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
8458 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
8459 @end raggedright
8460 @item linux symbols
8461 init_task.
8462 @item ChibiOS symbols
8463 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
8464 @item embKernel symbols
8465 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
8466 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
8467 @item mqx symbols
8468 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
8469 @end table
8470
8471 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
8472 some, eg. FreeRTOS, extra steps must be taken.
8473
8474 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
8475 along with the project:
8476
8477 @table @code
8478 @item FreeRTOS
8479 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
8480 @end table
8481
8482 @node Tcl Scripting API
8483 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
8484 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
8485 @cindex Tcl scripts
8486 @section API rules
8487
8488 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
8489 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
8490 of state information as an argument to each proc.
8491
8492 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
8493 pair list and lists.
8494
8495 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
8496 list.
8497
8498 @example
8499 > set foo(me) Duane
8500 > set foo(you) Oyvind
8501 > set foo(mouse) Micky
8502 > set foo(duck) Donald
8503 @end example
8504
8505 If one does this:
8506
8507 @example
8508 > set foo
8509 @end example
8510
8511 The result is:
8512
8513 @example
8514 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
8515 @end example
8516
8517 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
8518
8519 @verbatim
8520 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
8521 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
8522 }
8523 @end verbatim
8524
8525 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
8526 should be passed in to the proc in question.
8527
8528 @section Internal low-level Commands
8529
8530 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
8531 invoke directly.
8532
8533 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
8534 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
8535 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
8536
8537 @itemize @bullet
8538 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8539
8540 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
8541 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8542
8543 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
8544 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
8545
8546 Return information about the flash banks
8547
8548 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
8549
8550 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
8551 its execution. Example:
8552
8553 @example
8554 > capture "reset init"
8555 @end example
8556
8557 @end itemize
8558
8559 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
8560 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
8561 called "flash_banks".
8562
8563 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
8564
8565 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
8566 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
8567 holds one of the following values:
8568
8569 @itemize @bullet
8570 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
8571 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating sytem.
8572 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
8573 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
8574 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
8575 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating sytem
8576 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
8577 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
8578 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
8579 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
8580 @end itemize
8581
8582 Note: 'winxx' was choosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
8583
8584 @quotation Note
8585 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
8586 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
8587 @code{jim_platform} (because it
8588 is jim, not real tcl).
8589 @end quotation
8590
8591 @section Tcl RPC server
8592 @cindex RPC
8593
8594 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
8595 commands and receive the results.
8596
8597 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
8598 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
8599 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
8600 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
8601 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
8602
8603 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
8604 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
8605 @command{capture} command.
8606
8607 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
8608
8609 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
8610 @cindex RPC Notifications
8611
8612 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
8613 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
8614
8615 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
8616 in the following format.
8617
8618 @verbatim
8619 type target_event event [event-name]
8620 type target_state state [state-name]
8621 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
8622 @end verbatim
8623
8624 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
8625 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
8626 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
8627 Defaults to off.
8628
8629 @end deffn
8630
8631 @node FAQ
8632 @chapter FAQ
8633 @cindex faq
8634 @enumerate
8635 @anchor{faqrtck}
8636 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
8637 @cindex RTCK
8638 @cindex adaptive clocking
8639 @*
8640
8641 In digital circuit design it is often refered to as ``clock
8642 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
8643 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
8644 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
8645
8646 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
8647 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
8648 for example. There are 2 basic options:
8649 @enumerate
8650 @item
8651 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
8652 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
8653 @item
8654 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
8655 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
8656 @end enumerate
8657
8658 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
8659 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
8660 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
8661 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
8662 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
8663 power).
8664
8665 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
8666 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
8667 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
8668 ARM926 scenario).
8669 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
8670 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
8671 JTAG can use a faster clock.
8672
8673 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
8674 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
8675 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
8676 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
8677
8678 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
8679
8680 In order to make use of this,
8681 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
8682 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
8683
8684 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
8685 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
8686 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
8687 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
8688 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
8689
8690 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
8691 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
8692 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
8693 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
8694
8695 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
8696 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
8697 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
8698 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
8699 with a CPLD.
8700 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
8701 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
8702 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
8703 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
8704 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
8705 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
8706
8707 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
8708
8709 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
8710
8711 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
8712 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
8713 depending on the chips on your board.
8714 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
8715 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
8716 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
8717
8718 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
8719 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
8720 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
8721
8722 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
8723 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
8724 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
8725 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
8726
8727 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
8728 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
8729 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
8730 this way.
8731
8732 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
8733 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
8734 clock rate.
8735 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
8736 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
8737 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8738
8739 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
8740
8741 @example
8742 # Example: 1.234MHz
8743 adapter_khz 1234
8744 @end example
8745
8746
8747 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
8748
8749 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
8750 around Windows filenames.
8751
8752 @example
8753 > echo \a
8754
8755 > echo @{\a@}
8756 \a
8757 > echo "\a"
8758
8759 >
8760 @end example
8761
8762
8763 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
8764
8765 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
8766 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
8767 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
8768
8769 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a frontend like Insight or
8770 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
8771 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
8772
8773 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
8774 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
8775 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
8776
8777 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
8778
8779 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
8780 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
8781 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
8782 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
8783
8784 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
8785 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
8786 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
8787
8788 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
8789 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
8790
8791 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
8792 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
8793 memory read caused data abort".
8794
8795 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
8796 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
8797 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
8798 be done, feel free to add this here.
8799
8800 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
8801 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
8802 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
8803 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
8804 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
8805 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
8806 gracefully stops.
8807
8808 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
8809 your C code, do the same - artifically push some zeros onto the stack,
8810 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
8811
8812 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
8813 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
8814 bytes. Painful...
8815
8816
8817 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
8818 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
8819
8820 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
8821 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
8822 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
8823 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
8824 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
8825 reset, everything else should work fine.
8826
8827 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
8828 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
8829 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
8830 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
8831
8832 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
8833 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
8834 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
8835 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
8836
8837 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
8838
8839 @item @b{USB Power} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the
8840 following error messages: "Error: ft2232.c:201 ft2232_read(): FT_Read returned:
8841 4" and "Error: ft2232.c:365 ft2232_send_and_recv(): couldn't read from FT2232".
8842 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
8843
8844 First of all, the reason might be the USB power supply. Try using a self-powered
8845 hub instead of a direct connection to your computer. Secondly, the error code 4
8846 corresponds to an FT_IO_ERROR, which means that the driver for the FTDI USB
8847 chip ran into some sort of error - this points us to a USB problem.
8848
8849 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
8850 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
8851 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
8852
8853 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
8854 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
8855
8856 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
8857 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
8858 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
8859 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
8860 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
8861 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
8862 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
8863 clock frequency?
8864
8865 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
8866 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
8867 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
8868 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
8869 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
8870
8871 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
8872
8873 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
8874 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
8875 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
8876 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
8877 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
8878 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
8879 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
8880
8881 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
8882
8883 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
8884 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
8885 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
8886 up DRAM and loading it with code.
8887
8888 @anchor{faqtaporder}
8889 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
8890 particular order?
8891
8892 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
8893 the same order used by the hardware.
8894
8895 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example: ST
8896 Microsystems STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
8897 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
8898 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
8899 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
8900 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
8901
8902 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
8903 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
8904 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
8905 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
8906
8907 @itemize @bullet
8908 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
8909 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
8910 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
8911 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
8912 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
8913 @end itemize
8914
8915 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
8916
8917 @itemize @bullet
8918 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
8919 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
8920 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
8921 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
8922 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
8923 @end itemize
8924
8925
8926 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
8927 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
8928 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
8929
8930 TODO.
8931
8932 @end enumerate
8933
8934 @node Tcl Crash Course
8935 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
8936 @cindex Tcl
8937
8938 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
8939 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
8940 how the Tcl scripts work.
8941
8942 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
8943 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
8944 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
8945 OpenOCD.
8946
8947 @section Tcl Rule #1
8948 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
8949 @enumerate
8950 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
8951 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
8952 @end enumerate
8953
8954 The Tcl equal is this:
8955
8956 @enumerate
8957 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
8958 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
8959 @end enumerate
8960
8961 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
8962 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
8963
8964 @section Tcl Rule #1b
8965 There is a second pair of rules.
8966 @enumerate
8967 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
8968 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
8969 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
8970 in Tcl.
8971 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
8972 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
8973 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
8974 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
8975 @end enumerate
8976
8977 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
8978 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
8979 deliberatly. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
8980 Everything is a string}
8981
8982 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
8983 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
8984 difference is subtle.
8985 @enumerate
8986 @item Parse Time
8987 @item Evaluation Time
8988 @end enumerate
8989
8990 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
8991 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
8992 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
8993
8994 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
8995 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
8996 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC langauge ``let x
8997 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
8998
8999 @itemize @bullet
9000 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
9001 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
9002 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
9003 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
9004 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
9005 @example
9006 # bash example
9007 X=`date`
9008 echo "The Date is: $X"
9009 # Tcl example
9010 set X [date]
9011 puts "The Date is: $X"
9012 @end example
9013 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
9014 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
9015 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
9016 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
9017 is a string}
9018 @example
9019 set x "Dinner"
9020 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
9021 @end example
9022 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
9023 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
9024 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
9025 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
9026 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
9027 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
9028 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
9029 @end itemize
9030
9031 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
9032
9033 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
9034
9035 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
9036
9037 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
9038 the normal way.
9039
9040 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
9041 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
9042 line is immedatly executed.
9043
9044 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
9045 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
9046
9047 @subsection Command Execution
9048
9049 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
9050 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
9051 control flow operators.
9052
9053 Commands are executed like this:
9054
9055 @enumerate
9056 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
9057 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
9058 @item Repeat until End Of File.
9059 @end enumerate
9060
9061 It sort of works like this:
9062 @example
9063 for(;;)@{
9064 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
9065
9066 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
9067
9068 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
9069 @}
9070 @end example
9071
9072 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
9073 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
9074 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
9075 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
9076 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
9077 ``LookupCommand()''
9078
9079 @subsection The FOR command
9080
9081 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
9082 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
9083 command just like any other command.
9084
9085 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
9086 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
9087 are:
9088
9089 @enumerate 0
9090 @item The ascii text 'for'
9091 @item The start text
9092 @item The test expression
9093 @item The next text
9094 @item The body text
9095 @end enumerate
9096
9097 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
9098 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
9099 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
9100 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
9101
9102 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
9103 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
9104
9105 @example
9106 int
9107 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
9108 int *argc,
9109 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
9110 @end example
9111
9112 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
9113 introduced a byte-code parser and intepreter, but at the core, it
9114 still operates in the same basic way.
9115
9116 @subsection FOR command implementation
9117
9118 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
9119 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
9120
9121 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
9122
9123 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
9124
9125 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
9126 string. Commands can be seperated by semicolons, or newlines. While
9127 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
9128
9129 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
9130 expression and returns a value.
9131
9132 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
9133 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
9134 @example
9135 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
9136
9137 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
9138
9139 int
9140 MyForCommand( void *interp,
9141 int argc,
9142 char **argv )
9143 @{
9144 if( argc != 5 )@{
9145 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
9146 return ERROR;
9147 @}
9148
9149 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
9150
9151 // Execute the start statement.
9152 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
9153
9154 // Top of loop test
9155 for(;;)@{
9156 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
9157 if( i == 0 )
9158 break;
9159
9160 // Execute the body
9161 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
9162
9163 // Execute the LOOP part
9164 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
9165 @}
9166
9167 // Return no error
9168 SetResult( interp, "" );
9169 return SUCCESS;
9170 @}
9171 @end example
9172
9173 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
9174 in the same basic way.
9175
9176 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
9177
9178 @subsection source and find commands
9179 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
9180 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
9181 @*Remember the parsing rules
9182 @enumerate
9183 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
9184 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
9185 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
9186 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
9187 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
9188 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
9189 That character begins Tcl comments.)
9190 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
9191 it reads a file and executes as a script.
9192 @end enumerate
9193 @subsection format command
9194 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
9195 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
9196 @b{sprintf()}.
9197 @b{Example}
9198 @example
9199 set x 6
9200 set y 7
9201 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
9202 @end example
9203 @enumerate
9204 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
9205 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
9206 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
9207 @* Refer to Rule #1
9208 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
9209 @* Refer to Rule #1.
9210 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
9211 @end enumerate
9212 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
9213 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
9214 @example
9215 #1 Good
9216 proc someproc @{@} @{
9217 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
9218 @}
9219 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
9220 #2 Good - no variables
9221 $_TARGETNAME confgure -event foo "this ; that;"
9222 #3 Good Curly Braces
9223 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
9224 puts "Time: [date]"
9225 @}
9226 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
9227 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
9228 @end example
9229 @enumerate
9230 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
9231 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
9232 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
9233 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
9234 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
9235 command.
9236 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
9237 @*There are 4 examples:
9238 @enumerate
9239 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
9240 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands seperated by semicolons
9241 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
9242 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
9243 @end enumerate
9244
9245 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
9246 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
9247 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
9248
9249 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
9250 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
9251 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
9252 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
9253 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
9254 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
9255 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
9256 @end enumerate
9257 @subsection Global Variables
9258 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
9259 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
9260 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
9261 @example
9262 proc myproc @{ @} @{
9263 set y 0 #Local variable Y
9264 global x #Global variable X
9265 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
9266 @}
9267 @end example
9268 @section Other Tcl Hacks
9269 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
9270 @example
9271 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
9272 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
9273 # Create var name
9274 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
9275 # Make it a global
9276 global $vn
9277 # Set it.
9278 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
9279 @}
9280 @end example
9281 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
9282 @example
9283 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
9284 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
9285 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
9286 @}
9287 @end example
9288
9289 @include fdl.texi
9290
9291 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
9292 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
9293 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
9294 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
9295 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
9296 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
9297
9298 @printindex cp
9299
9300 @node Command and Driver Index
9301 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
9302 @printindex fn
9303
9304 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)